blob: 1ad0942b625ff0e921ac5740450e2747d4e5bf06 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau33205c22020-07-07 16:35:28 +02005 version 2.3
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau5902ad92021-02-06 10:49:57 +01007 2021/02/06
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand83972542020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001018.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001038.3. Advanced logging options
1048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1088.4. Timing events
1098.5. Session state at disconnection
1108.6. Non-printable characters
1118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1138.9. Examples of logs
114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001159. Supported filters
1169.1. Trace
1179.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001189.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001199.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001209.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200121
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012210. FastCGI applications
12310.1. Setup
12410.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12510.1.2. Proxy section
12610.1.3. Example
12710.2. Default parameters
12810.3. Limitations
129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130
1311. Quick reminder about HTTP
132----------------------------
133
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
136on almost anything found in the contents.
137
138However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
139formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
140correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
141
142
1431.1. The HTTP transaction model
144-------------------------------
145
146The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100147to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100148from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
149connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150will involve a new connection :
151
152 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
153
154In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
155establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
156by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
157length.
158
159Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
160to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
161however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
162response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
163header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
168power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
169but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
174second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
175page :
176
177 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
178
179This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
180latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
181correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
182the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100183server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100185The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
186time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
187are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
188parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
189carry the stream identifier.
190
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
192connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
193leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
195processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
196waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200197
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200198HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100199 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
200 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100201 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200203 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206
2071.2. HTTP request
208-----------------
209
210First, let's consider this HTTP request :
211
212 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
215 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
216 3 User-agent: my small browser
217 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
218 5 Accept: image/png
219
220
2211.2.1. The Request line
222-----------------------
223
224Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
225
226 - a METHOD : GET
227 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
228 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
229
230All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
231which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
232followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
233is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
234desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
235the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
236
237The URI itself can have several forms :
238
239 - A "relative URI" :
240
241 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
244 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
245
246 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
247
248 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
249
250 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
251 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
252 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
253 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
254 must accept this form too.
255
256 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
257 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
258 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200260 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
261 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
262 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
263 other protocols too.
264
265In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
266mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
267on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
268It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
269specific to the language, framework or application in use.
270
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100271HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100272assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200274
2751.2.2. The request headers
276--------------------------
277
278The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
279beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
280an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
281Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
282values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
283encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
284the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
285define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
286
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100287Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100289"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200290as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
291normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
292representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
293HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
295The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
296that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
297is one valid form of empty line.
298
299Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
300headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
301about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
302application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
303
304Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000305 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
307 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
308 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
309
310
3111.3. HTTP response
312------------------
313
314An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
315messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
316
317 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100318 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200319 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
320 2 Content-length: 350
321 3 Content-Type: text/html
322
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200323As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
324codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
325response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100326continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
327the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
328following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
329sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
330(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
331correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
332such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
333state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
334over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
335if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
336information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200337
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200338
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003391.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200340------------------------
341
342Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
343
344 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
345 - a status code : 200
346 - a reason : OK
347
348The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100349 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
350 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
351 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
352 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
353 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200354
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000355Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100356"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200357found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
358messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
359or "Authentication Required".
360
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362
363 Code When / reason
364 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
365 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
366 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
367 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100368 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370 400 for an invalid or too large request
371 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
372 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200373 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100374 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100376 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
377 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
379 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
380 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200381 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
383 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
384 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
385
386The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3874.2).
388
389
3901.3.2. The response headers
391---------------------------
392
393Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
394the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
395details.
396
397
3982. Configuring HAProxy
399----------------------
400
4012.1. Configuration file format
402------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200403
404HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
405
406 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100407 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombsdab4ba62021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700408 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100409 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200410
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100411The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
412a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100414 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
415
416 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
417
418 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
419 tab characters
420
421 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
422 keyword sequences listed in this document
423
424 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
425 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
426 parts of the configuration, or expressions
427
428 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
429 are supported
430
431 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
432 section
433
434This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
435generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
436figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
437
438First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
439the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
440a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
441word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
442follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
443the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
444the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
445the parts that need to be addressed.
446
447A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
448requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
449extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
450the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
451section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
452section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
453not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
454
455A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
456each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
457a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
458start a new one.
459
460Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
461that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
462applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
463"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
464processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
465ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
466which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
467In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
468of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
469identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
470such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4712, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
472
473 listen foo
474 bind :80
475
476 listen bar
477 bind :81
478
479Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
480spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
481of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
482following configurations are strictly equivalent:
483
484 global#this is the global section
485 daemon#daemonize
486 frontend foo
487 mode http # or tcp
488
489and:
490
491 global
492 daemon
493
494 # this is the public web frontend
495 frontend foo
496 mode http
497
498The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
499new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
500other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
501section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
502section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
503at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
504
505Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
506are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
507editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
508support automatic indent.
509
510In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
511positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
512modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
513anymore, and is not recommended.
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200515
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005162.2. Quoting and escaping
517-------------------------
518
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100519In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
520that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
521possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
522in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
523('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200524
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100525This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
526very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
527the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
528also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
529delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
530word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
531remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
534(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
535
536Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
537backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200538
539 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
540 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
541 \\ to use a backslash
542 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
543 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
544
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100545In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
546C-language representation:
547
548 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
549 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
550 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
551 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
552
553Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
554or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
555of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200556
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100557 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200558 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
559 # hash as a comment start
560
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100561Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
562evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
563dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
564backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200565
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100566Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
567character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
568is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200569
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
571entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
572name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
573represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
574hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200575
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100576 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
577 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
578 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
579 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
580 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
581 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
582 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
583 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
584 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
585 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
586 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200587
588 Example:
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100589 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200590 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
591 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
592 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
593 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
594 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
595
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100596There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
597necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
598by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
599they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
600escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
601characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
602case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
603if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
604own quotes.
605
606The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
607quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
608not always obvious is that the delimitors used inside must first be escaped or
609quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
610
611Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
612arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
613
614 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
615 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
616
617Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
618"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
619cannot write:
620
621 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
622
623because we would like the string to cut like this:
624
625 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
626 |---------|----|-|
627 arg1 _/ / /
628 arg2 __________/ /
629 arg3 ______________/
630
631but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
632parenthesis then garbage:
633
634 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
635 |--------|--------|
636 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
637 trailing garbage _________/
638
639The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
640quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
641processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
642this word:
643
644 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
645 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
646 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
647
648So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
649still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
650the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
651the second level:
652
653 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
654 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
655 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
656 |---------||----|-|
657 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
658 arg2=blah ___________/ /
659 arg3=g _______________/
660
661Another approch consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
662double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
663
664 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
665 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
666 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
667 |---------||----|-|
668 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
669 arg2 ___________/ /
670 arg3 _______________/
671
672When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
673appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
674string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
675thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
676
677 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
678 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
679 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
680 |-------------| |-----||-|
681 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
682 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
683 arg3 ______________________/
684
685Remember that backslahes are not escape characters withing single quotes and
686that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
687quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
688single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
689level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
690
691When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
692double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
693and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
694a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
695a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
696the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
697regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
698around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
699more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200700
701
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007022.3. Environment variables
703--------------------------
704
705HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
706interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
707configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
708optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
709shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200710underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
711list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
712arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
713before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200714
715 Example:
716
717 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
718
719 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
720
721 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
722
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200723Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
724file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200725
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200726* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
727 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
728
729* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
730 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
731 directory.
732
733* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
734
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500735* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200736 processes, separated by semicolons.
737
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500738* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200739 CLI, separated by semicolons.
740
741See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200742
7432.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200744----------------
745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100746Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100747values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
748otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
749numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
750for every keyword. Supported units are :
751
752 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
753 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
754 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
755 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
756 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
757 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
758
759
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00007602.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200761-------------
762
763 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
764 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
765 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
766 global
767 daemon
768 maxconn 256
769
770 defaults
771 mode http
772 timeout connect 5000ms
773 timeout client 50000ms
774 timeout server 50000ms
775
776 frontend http-in
777 bind *:80
778 default_backend servers
779
780 backend servers
781 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
782
783
784 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
785 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
786 global
787 daemon
788 maxconn 256
789
790 defaults
791 mode http
792 timeout connect 5000ms
793 timeout client 50000ms
794 timeout server 50000ms
795
796 listen http-in
797 bind *:80
798 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
799
800
801Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
802
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100803 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200804
805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008063. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200807--------------------
808
809Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
810are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
811of them have command-line equivalents.
812
813The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
814
815 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200816 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200817 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200818 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200819 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200821 - description
822 - deviceatlas-json-file
823 - deviceatlas-log-level
824 - deviceatlas-separator
825 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900826 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200827 - gid
828 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100829 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200830 - h1-case-adjust
831 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100832 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100833 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100834 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200835 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200836 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200837 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100838 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200839 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100840 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200841 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200842 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200843 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200844 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200845 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200846 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100847 - presetenv
848 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200849 - uid
850 - ulimit-n
851 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200852 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100853 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200854 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200855 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200856 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200857 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200858 - ssl-default-bind-options
859 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200860 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200861 - ssl-default-server-options
862 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100863 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200864 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100865 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100866 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100867 - 51degrees-data-file
868 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200869 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200870 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200871 - wurfl-data-file
872 - wurfl-information-list
873 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200874 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100875 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100876
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200877 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100878 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200879 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200880 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200881 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100882 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100883 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100884 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200885 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200886 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200887 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200888 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200889 - noepoll
890 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000891 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200892 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100893 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300894 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000895 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100896 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200897 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200898 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200899 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000900 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000901 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200902 - tune.buffers.limit
903 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200904 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200905 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100906 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200907 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200908 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200909 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200910 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100911 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200912 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200913 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200914 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100915 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100916 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100917 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100918 - tune.lua.session-timeout
919 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200920 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100921 - tune.maxaccept
922 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200923 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200924 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200925 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200926 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
927 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100928 - tune.rcvbuf.client
929 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100930 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200931 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200932 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100933 - tune.sndbuf.client
934 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100935 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200936 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100937 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200938 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100939 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200940 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200941 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100942 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200943 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100944 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200945 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
946 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
947 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100948 - tune.zlib.memlevel
949 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100950
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200951 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200952 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200953 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200954
955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009563.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200957------------------------------------
958
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200959ca-base <dir>
960 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100961 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
962 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
963 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200964
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200965chroot <jail dir>
966 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
967 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
968 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
969 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
970 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100971 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100972
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100973cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
974 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
975 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
976 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
977 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
978 set. These sets have the format
979
980 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
981
982 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100983 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100984 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
985 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100986 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
987 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100988 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100989 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100990 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100991 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100992 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
993 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
994 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
995 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100996
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100997 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
998 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
999 on the machine's word size.
1000
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001001 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001002 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1003 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1004 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1005 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1006 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1007 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001008
1009 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001010 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1011
1012 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1013 # first 4 CPUs
1014
1015 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1016 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1017 # word size.
1018
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001019 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001020 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001021 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1022 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1023 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1024
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001025 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1026 # and so on.
1027 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1028 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1029 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1030
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001031 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001032 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1033 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1034 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1035
1036 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1037 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1038 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1039
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001040 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1041 # and a thread range.
1042 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1043 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1044 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1045
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001046crt-base <dir>
1047 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001048 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1049 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001050
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001051daemon
1052 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1053 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001054 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1055 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001056
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001057deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1058 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001059 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001060
1061deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001062 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001063 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1064
1065deviceatlas-separator <char>
1066 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1067 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1068
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001069deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001070 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1071 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1072 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001073
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001074external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001075 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1076 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001077 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1078 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1079 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1080 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1081 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001082
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001083gid <number>
Thayne McCombsdab4ba62021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001084 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001085 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1086 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001087 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1088 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001089 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001090
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001091group <group name>
1092 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1093 See also "gid" and "user".
1094
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001095hard-stop-after <time>
1096 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1097
1098 Arguments :
1099 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1100 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1101 SIGUSR1 signal.
1102
1103 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1104 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1105 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1106
1107 Example:
1108 global
1109 hard-stop-after 30s
1110
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001111h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1112 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1113 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1114 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1115 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001116 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001117 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1118 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1119 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1120 specified in a proxy.
1121
1122 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1123 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1124 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1125 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1126 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1127 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1128 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1129
1130 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1131 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1132 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1133 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1134 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1135
1136 Example:
1137 global
1138 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1139
1140 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1141 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1142
1143h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1144 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1145 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1146 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1147 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1148 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1149 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1150 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1151 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1152
1153 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1154 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1155 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1156
1157 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1158 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1159
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001160insecure-fork-wanted
1161 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1162 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1163 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1164 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1165 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1166 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1167 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1168 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1169 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1170 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1171 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1172 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1173 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1174 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1175 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1176 disable it.
1177
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001178insecure-setuid-wanted
1179 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1180 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1181 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1182 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1183 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1184 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1185 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1186 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1187 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1188 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1189 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1190 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1191 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1192 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1193
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001194issuers-chain-path <dir>
1195 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1196 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1197 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1198 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1199 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1200 "issuers-chain-path".
1201 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1202 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1203 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1204 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1205 will share the chain in memory.
1206
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001207localpeer <name>
1208 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1209 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1210 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1211 the configuration parsing.
1212
1213 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1214 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1215
Jan Wagnerf2f5c4e2020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001216log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001217 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001218 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001219 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001220 configured with "log global".
1221
1222 <address> can be one of:
1223
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001224 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001225 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1226 port).
1227
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001228 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1229 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1230 port).
1231
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001232 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001233 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1234 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001235 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001236
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001237 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1238 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1239 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1240 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1241 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1242 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1243 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1244 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1245 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1246 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1247 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1248 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1249 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1250 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001251 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1252 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001253
1254 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1255 "fd@2", see above.
1256
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001257 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1258 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1259 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1260 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1261 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1262
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001263 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1264 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001265
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001266 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1267 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1268 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1269 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1270 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1271 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1272 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1273 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1274 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1275 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001276 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1277 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001278
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001279 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1280 one of the following :
1281
Emeric Bruna0338b92020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001282 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1283 field is stripped. This is the default.
1284 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1285 rfc3164.
1286
1287 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001288 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1289
1290 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1291 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1292
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001293 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1294 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1295 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1296 designed to be used with a local log server.
1297
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001298 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1299 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1300 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1301 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1302 logger consumes.
1303
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001304 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1305 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1306 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1307 used with a local log server.
1308
1309 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1310 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1311 designed to be used with a local log server.
1312
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001313 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1314 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1315 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1316 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1317
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001318 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1319 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1320 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1321 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1322 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1323
1324 <sample_size>
1325 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1326 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1327 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1328 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1329 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1330
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001331 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001332
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001333 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1334 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1335 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1336
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001337 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1338 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1339 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1340 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001341
1342 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001343 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1344 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1345 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1346 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1347 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1348 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001349
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001350 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001351
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001352log-send-hostname [<string>]
1353 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1354 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1355 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1356 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1357 the logs.
1358
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001359log-tag <string>
1360 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1361 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1362 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001363 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001364
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001365lua-load <file>
1366 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1367 used multiple times.
1368
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001369lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1370 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1371 variable.
1372 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1373 to "path".
1374
1375 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1376 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1377 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1378 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1379 will be checked earlier.
1380
1381 As an example by specifying the following path:
1382
1383 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1384 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1385
1386 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1387 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1388 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1389 paths if that does not exist either.
1390
1391 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1392 documentation.
1393
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001394master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001395 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1396 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1397 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001398 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001399 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1400 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001401 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1402 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1403 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1404 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1405 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001406
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001407 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001408
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001409mworker-max-reloads <number>
1410 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001411 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001412 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1413 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1414 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1415
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001416nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001417 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1418 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1419 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001420 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1421 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001422 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1423 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1424 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001425
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001426nbthread <number>
1427 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001428 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1429 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1430 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1431 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1432 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001433 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1434 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1435 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1436 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1437 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1438 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1439 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001440
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001441pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001442 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1443 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1444 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1445 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001446
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001447pp2-never-send-local
1448 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1449 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1450 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1451 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1452 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1453 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1454 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1455 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1456 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1457 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1458 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1459
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001460presetenv <name> <value>
1461 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1462 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1463 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1464 and "unsetenv".
1465
1466resetenv [<name> ...]
1467 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1468 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1469 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1470 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1471 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1472 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1473 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1474 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1475
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001476stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001477 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1478 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1479 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1480 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1481 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1482 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001483 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001484 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1485 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1486 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1487 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001488
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001489server-state-base <directory>
1490 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001491 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1492 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001493
1494server-state-file <file>
1495 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1496 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1497 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1498 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1499 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1500 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1501 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1502 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001503 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1504 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001505
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001506setenv <name> <value>
1507 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1508 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1509 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1510 and "unsetenv".
1511
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001512set-dumpable
1513 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001514 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1515 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1516 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1517 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1518 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1519 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1520 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1521 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1522 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1523 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1524 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1525 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1526 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1527 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1528 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1529 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1530 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001531
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001532ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1533 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1534 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001535 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001536 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001537 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1538 information and recommendations see e.g.
1539 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1540 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1541 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1542 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001543
1544ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1545 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1546 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1547 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1548 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1549 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001550 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1551 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1552 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001553 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001554
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001555ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1556 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1557 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1558 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1559 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1560 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1561
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001562ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1563 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1564 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1565 keyword to see available options.
1566
1567 Example:
1568 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001569 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001570
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001571ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1572 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1573 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001574 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001575 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001576 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1577 information and recommendations see e.g.
1578 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1579 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1580 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1581 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1582 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001583
1584ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1585 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1586 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1587 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1588 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1589 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001590 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1591 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1592 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1593 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001594
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001595ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1596 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1597 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1598 keyword to see available options.
1599
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001600ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1601 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1602 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1603 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001604 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001605 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001606 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1607 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1608 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1609 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001610 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1611 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1612 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1613
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001614ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1615 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1616 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001617 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001618 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001619 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1620
1621 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001622
1623 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1624 and won't try to remove them.
1625
1626 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1627
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001628ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001629 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001630 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1631 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001632
1633 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1634 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1635 optimize the startup time.
1636
1637 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1638 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1639 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1640
1641 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001642 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001643
1644 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001645 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1646
1647 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1648 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1649 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1650 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1651 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1652 bind configuration..
1653
1654 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1655 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1656 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1657 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1658 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1659 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1660 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1661 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1662
1663 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1664
1665 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1666 a cert bundle.
1667
1668 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1669 separately in several "crt".
1670
1671 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1672 since files are loading separately.
1673
1674 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1675 required to commit them.
1676
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001677 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001678 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001679
1680 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1681
1682 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1683
1684 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1685 not provided in the PEM file.
1686
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001687 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1688 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1689
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001690 The default behavior is "all".
1691
1692 Example:
1693 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1694 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1695 ssl-load-extra-files none
1696
1697 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1698
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001699ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1700 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1701 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1702 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1703
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001704ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001705 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001706 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1707 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1708 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1709 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1710 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1711 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001712 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001713
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001714stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1715 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1716 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1717 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001718 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001719 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001720
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001721 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1722 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1723 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001724
1725stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1726 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1727 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001728 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001729
1730stats maxconn <connections>
1731 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1732 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1733
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001734uid <number>
Thayne McCombsdab4ba62021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001735 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001736 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1737 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1738 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1739
1740ulimit-n <number>
1741 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1742 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1743 option.
1744
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001745unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1746 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1747
1748 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1749 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1750 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1751 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1752 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1753 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1754 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1755 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1756 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1757 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1758
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001759unsetenv [<name> ...]
1760 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1761 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1762 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1763 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1764 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1765 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1766 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1767
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001768user <user name>
1769 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1770 See also "uid" and "group".
1771
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001772node <name>
1773 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1774
1775 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1776 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1777 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1778 traffic.
1779
1780description <text>
1781 Add a text that describes the instance.
1782
1783 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1784 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1785 "<" and ">" characters.
1786
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100178751degrees-data-file <file path>
1788 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001789 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001790
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001791 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001792 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1793
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000179451degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001795 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1796 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1797 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1798
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001799 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001800 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1801
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200180251degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001803 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1804 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1805
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001806 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1807 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1808
180951degrees-cache-size <number>
1810 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1811 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1812 By default, this cache is disabled.
1813
1814 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001815 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1816
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001817wurfl-data-file <file path>
1818 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1819 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1820
1821 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1822 with USE_WURFL=1.
1823
1824wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1825 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1826 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1827 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1828
1829 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1830
1831 Valid WURFL properties are:
1832 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1833
1834 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1835 device.
1836
1837 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1838 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1839
1840 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1841 particular web request.
1842
1843 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1844 used Libwurfl API version.
1845
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001846 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1847 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1848
1849 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1850 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1851
1852 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1853
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001854 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1855 with USE_WURFL=1.
1856
1857wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1858 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1859 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1860
1861 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1862 with USE_WURFL=1.
1863
1864wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1865 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1866 thus before the chroot.
1867
1868 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1869 with USE_WURFL=1.
1870
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001871wurfl-cache-size <size>
1872 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1873 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001874 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001875 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001876
1877 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1878 with USE_WURFL=1.
1879
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001880strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001881 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1882 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1883 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1884 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1885 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001886
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018873.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001888-----------------------
1889
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001890busy-polling
1891 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1892 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1893 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1894 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1895 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1896 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1897 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1898 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1899 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1900 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1901 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1902 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1903 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1904 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1905 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1906 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1907 "poll" pollers.
1908
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001909 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1910 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1911 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1912
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001913max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1914 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1915 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1916 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1917 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1918 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1919 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1920 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1921 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1922
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001923maxconn <number>
1924 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1925 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1926 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001927 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1928 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1929 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1930 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001931 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1932 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1933 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1934 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1935 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1936 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001937
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001938maxconnrate <number>
1939 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1940 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1941 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1942 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1943 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1944 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1945 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1946 fairness.
1947
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001948maxcomprate <number>
1949 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001950 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001951 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1952 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1953 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001954 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001955 default value.
1956
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001957maxcompcpuusage <number>
1958 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1959 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1960 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1961 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1962 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1963 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1964 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1965 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1966
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001967maxpipes <number>
1968 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1969 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1970 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1971 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1972 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1973 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1974
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001975maxsessrate <number>
1976 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1977 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1978 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1979 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1980 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1981 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1982 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1983 fairness.
1984
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001985maxsslconn <number>
1986 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1987 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1988 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1989 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1990 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1991 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1992 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001993 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1994 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1995 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1996 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1997 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1998 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1999 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002000
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002001maxsslrate <number>
2002 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2003 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2004 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2005 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2006 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2007 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2008 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2009 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2010 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2011 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2012
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002013maxzlibmem <number>
2014 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2015 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2016 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002017 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2018 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2019 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2020
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002021noepoll
2022 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2023 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002024 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002025
2026nokqueue
2027 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2028 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2029 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2030
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002031noevports
2032 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2033 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2034 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2035 also "nopoll".
2036
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002037nopoll
2038 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2039 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002040 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002041 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2042 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002043
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002044nosplice
2045 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002046 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002047 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002048 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002049 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2050 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2051 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2052 "option splice-response".
2053
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002054nogetaddrinfo
2055 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2056 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2057
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002058noreuseport
2059 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2060 command line argument "-dR".
2061
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002062profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2063 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2064 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2065 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2066 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002067 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002068 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2069 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2070 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2071 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2072
2073 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2074 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2075 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2076 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2077 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002078 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2079 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2080 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2081 CLI.
2082
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002083spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002084 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2085 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2086 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2087 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2088 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2089 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002090
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002091ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002092 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002093 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002094 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2095 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2096 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2097 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2098 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002099 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2100 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002101 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2102 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2103 openssl configuration file uses:
2104 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2105
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002106ssl-mode-async
2107 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002108 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002109 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2110 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2111 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002112 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002113 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002114
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002115tune.buffers.limit <number>
2116 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2117 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2118 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2119 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2120 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002121 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002122 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2123 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2124 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2125 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2126 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2127 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2128 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2129 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2130 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2131
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002132tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2133 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2134 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2135 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2136 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2137
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002138tune.bufsize <number>
2139 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2140 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2141 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2142 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2143 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2144 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2145 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002146 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2147 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2148 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002149 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002150 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2151 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2152 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002153
Christopher Faulet7151a122020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002154tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2155 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002156
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002157tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2158 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2159 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2160 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2161 this value. The default value is 1.
2162
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002163tune.fail-alloc
2164 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2165 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2166 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2167 gracefully.
2168
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002169tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2170 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2171 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2172 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2173 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2174 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2175
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002176tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2177 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2178 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2179 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2180 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2181 change it.
2182
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002183tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2184 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002185 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2186 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002187 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2188 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2189 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2190 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2191 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2192
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002193tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2194 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2195 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2196 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2197 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2198 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2199 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2200 recommended not to change this value.
2201
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002202tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2203 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2204 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2205 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2206 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2207 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2208 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2209 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2210
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002211tune.http.cookielen <number>
2212 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2213 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2214 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2215 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2216 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2217 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2218 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2219 to change this value.
2220
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002221tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002222 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2223 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002224 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002225 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002226 configuration directives too.
2227 The default value is 1024.
2228
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002229tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2230 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2231 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2232 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2233 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2234 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2235 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002236 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2237 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2238 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002239
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002240tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2241 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2242 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2243 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2244 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2245 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2246 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
2247 this option to "off". The default is on.
2248
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002249tune.idletimer <timeout>
2250 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2251 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2252 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2253 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2254 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2255 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002256 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002257 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002258 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2259
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002260tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2261 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2262 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2263 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2264 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2265 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2266 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2267 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2268 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2269 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2270
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002271tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2272 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002273 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002274 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2275 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002276 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002277 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2278 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2279
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002280tune.lua.maxmem
2281 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2282 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2283 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2284 memory.
2285
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002286tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2287 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002288 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2289 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002290 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002291
2292tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2293 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2294 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2295 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2296 check servers.
2297
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002298tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2299 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2300 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2301 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002302 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002303
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002304tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002305 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2306 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2307 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2308 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2309 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2310 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2311 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2312 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2313 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2314 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002315
2316tune.maxpollevents <number>
2317 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2318 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2319 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2320 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2321 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2322
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002323tune.maxrewrite <number>
2324 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2325 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2326 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2327 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2328 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2329 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2330 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2331 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2332 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2333 bufsize.
2334
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002335tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2336 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2337 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2338 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2339 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2340 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2341 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2342 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2343 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2344 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002345 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2346 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002347 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2348 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2349 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2350 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2351 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2352 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2353 setting this parameter to 0.
2354
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002355tune.pipesize <number>
2356 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2357 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2358 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2359 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2360 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2361 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2362
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002363tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2364 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2365 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2366 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2367 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2368 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2369 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002370 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002371
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002372tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2373 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2374 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2375 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2376 default is 20.
2377
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002378tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2379tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2380 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2381 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2382 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002383 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002384 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002385 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2386 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2387
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002388tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002389 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002390 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2391 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2392 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2393 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2394
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002395tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002396 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002397 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002398 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2399 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2400 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2401
2402tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2403 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2404 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2405 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2406 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2407 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2408 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2409 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2410 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2411 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002412
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002413tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2414tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2415 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2416 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2417 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002418 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002419 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002420 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2421 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2422 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2423 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2424 notifying haproxy again.
2425
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002426tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002427 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2428 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2429 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002430 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002431 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002432 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002433 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2434 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2435 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002436 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2437 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002438
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002439tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002440 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002441 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2442 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2443 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2444 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2445 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2446
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002447tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2448 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2449 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2450 performances. This is disabled by default.
2451
2452 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2453 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2454
2455 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2456
2457 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2458
2459 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2460
2461 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2462 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2463 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2464
2465 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2466 converted.
2467
2468 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2469 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2470 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2471 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2472 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2473 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2474 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002475 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2476 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002477
2478 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2479
2480 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2481 only need this line:
2482
2483 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2484
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002485tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2486 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002487 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002488 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2489 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2490 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2491 being used for too long.
2492
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002493tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2494 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2495 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2496 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2497 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2498 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2499 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2500 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2501 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2502 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2503 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002504 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002505 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002506
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002507tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2508 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2509 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2510 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2511 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002512 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002513 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2514 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002515 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2516 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002517
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002518tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2519 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2520 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2521 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2522 1000 entries.
2523
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002524tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2525 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2526 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2527 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2528
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002529tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002530tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002531tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2532tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2533tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002534 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2535 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2536 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2537 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2538 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2539 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2540 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2541 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002542
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002543 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2544 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2545 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2546 all available space is consumed.
2547 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2548 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2549 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002550
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002551tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2552 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002553 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002554 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002555 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002556 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2557
2558tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2559 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2560 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002561 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2562 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002563
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025643.3. Debugging
2565--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002566
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002567quiet
2568 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2569 line argument "-q".
2570
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002571zero-warning
2572 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2573 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2574 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2575 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2576 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2577 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2578
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002579
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010025803.4. Userlists
2581--------------
2582It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2583http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2584it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2585
2586userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002587 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002588 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2589
2590group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002591 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002592 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2593 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2594
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002595user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2596 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002597 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2598 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002599 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2600 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2601 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2602 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002603
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002604 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2605 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2606 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2607 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2608 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2609 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2610 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2611 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2612 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002613
2614 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002615 userlist L1
2616 group G1 users tiger,scott
2617 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002618
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002619 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2620 user scott insecure-password elgato
2621 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002622
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002623 userlist L2
2624 group G1
2625 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002626
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002627 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2628 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2629 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002630
2631 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002632
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002633
26343.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002635----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002636It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2637several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2638instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2639values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2640automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2641In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2642using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2643tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2644reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2645Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2646that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2647each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002648
2649peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002650 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002651 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2652
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002653bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2654 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2655 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2656
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002657disabled
2658 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2659 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2660 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2661
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002662default-bind [param*]
2663 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2664
2665default-server [param*]
2666 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2667
2668 Arguments:
2669 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2670 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2671 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2672 details.
2673
2674
2675 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2676
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002677enable
2678 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2679
Jan Wagnerf2f5c4e2020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002680log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002681 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2682 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2683 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2684 more details.
2685
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002686peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002687 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2688 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002689 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2690 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2691 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2692 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2693 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002694
2695 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2696 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2697
2698 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002699 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2700 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2701 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002702
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002703 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2704 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002705
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002706 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2707 "server" keyword explanation below).
2708
2709server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002710 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002711 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2712 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2713 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2714 of this "peers" section).
2715 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2716
2717
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002718 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002719 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002720 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002721 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2722 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2723 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002724
2725 backend mybackend
2726 mode tcp
2727 balance roundrobin
2728 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2729 stick on src
2730
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002731 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2732 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002733
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002734 Example:
2735 peers mypeers
2736 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2737 default-server ssl verify none
2738 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2739 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002740
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002741
2742table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2743 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2744
2745 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2746 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002747 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002748 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2749 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2750 "stick-table" keyword).
2751
2752 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2753 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2754 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2755 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2756 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2757 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2758 of the stick-table name as follows:
2759
2760 peers mypeers
2761 peer A ...
2762 peer B ...
2763 table t1 ...
2764
2765 frontend fe1
2766 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2767
2768 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2769 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2770
2771 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2772 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2773 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2774 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2775 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2776 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2777 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2778
2779 peers mypeers
2780 peer A ...
2781 peer B ...
2782 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2783
2784 backend t1
2785 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2786
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002787 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002788 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2789 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2790
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090027913.6. Mailers
2792------------
2793It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2794If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2795in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2796
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002797mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002798 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2799 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2800
2801mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2802 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2803
2804 Example:
2805 mailers mymailers
2806 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2807 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2808
2809 backend mybackend
2810 mode tcp
2811 balance roundrobin
2812
2813 email-alert mailers mymailers
2814 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2815 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2816
2817 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2818 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2819
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002820timeout mail <time>
2821 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2822 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2823 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2824 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2825
2826 Example:
2827 mailers mymailers
2828 timeout mail 20s
2829 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002830
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020028313.7. Programs
2832-------------
2833In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2834master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2835managed the same way as the workers.
2836
2837During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2838sequence as a worker:
2839
2840 - the master is re-executed
2841 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2842 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2843 instance of the program
2844
2845During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2846
2847program <name>
2848 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2849 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2850 the management guide).
2851
2852command <command> [arguments*]
2853 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2854 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2855 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2856 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2857
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002858user <user name>
2859 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2860 See also "group".
2861
2862group <group name>
2863 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2864 See also "user".
2865
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002866option start-on-reload
2867no option start-on-reload
2868 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2869 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2870 program section.
2871
2872
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010028733.8. HTTP-errors
2874----------------
2875
2876It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2877imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2878several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2879
2880http-errors <name>
2881 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2882 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2883
2884errorfile <code> <file>
2885 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2886
2887 Arguments :
2888 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002889 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2890 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002891
2892 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2893 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2894 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2895 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2896 before any chroot is performed.
2897
2898 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2899
2900 Example:
2901 http-errors website-1
2902 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2903 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2904 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2905
2906 http-errors website-2
2907 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2908 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2909 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2910
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020029113.9. Rings
2912----------
2913
2914It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2915servers or traces.
2916
2917ring <ringname>
2918 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2919
2920description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002921 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002922 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2923
2924format <format>
2925 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2926
2927 Arguments:
2928 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2929 one of the following :
2930
2931 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2932 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2933 designed to be used with a local log server.
2934
Emeric Bruna0338b92020-11-27 16:24:34 +01002935 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
2936 field is stripped. This is the default.
2937 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
2938 rfc3164.
2939
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002940 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2941 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2942 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2943 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2944 is the default.
2945
Emeric Bruna0338b92020-11-27 16:24:34 +01002946 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002947 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2948
2949 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2950 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2951
2952 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2953 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2954 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2955 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2956 logger consumes.
2957
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02002958 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
2959 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
2960 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
2961 with a local log server.
2962
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002963 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2964 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2965 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2966 used with a local log server.
2967
2968maxlen <length>
2969 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2970 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2971 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2972
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002973server <name> <address> [param*]
2974 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2975 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2976 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2977 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2978 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2979 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2980 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2981 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2982 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002983 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2984 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002985
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002986size <size>
2987 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2988 set to BUFSIZE.
2989
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002990timeout connect <timeout>
2991 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2992
2993 Arguments :
2994 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2995 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2996 as explained at the top of this document.
2997
2998timeout server <timeout>
2999 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3000
3001 Arguments :
3002 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3003 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3004 as explained at the top of this document.
3005
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003006 Example:
3007 global
3008 log ring@myring local7
3009
3010 ring myring
3011 description "My local buffer"
3012 format rfc3164
3013 maxlen 1200
3014 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003015 timeout connect 5s
3016 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003017 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003018
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020030193.10. Log forwarding
3020-------------------
3021
3022It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3023haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3024
3025log-forward <name>
3026 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3027
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003028backlog <conns>
3029 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3030 on connections accept.
3031
3032bind <addr> [param*]
3033 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003034 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3035 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3036 syslog protocol over TCP.
3037 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003038 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3039
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003040dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003041 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3042 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3043 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3044 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003045 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003046
3047log global
Jan Wagnerf2f5c4e2020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003048log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003049 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3050 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3051 documentation.
3052 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3053 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3054 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3055 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3056 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3057
3058 Example:
3059 global
3060 log stderr format iso local7
3061
3062 ring myring
3063 description "My local buffer"
3064 format rfc5424
3065 maxlen 1200
3066 size 32764
3067 timeout connect 5s
3068 timeout server 10s
3069 # syslog tcp server
3070 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3071
3072 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003073 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3074 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003075 # all messages on stderr
3076 log global
3077 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3078 log ring@myring local0
3079 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3080 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3081 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3082 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3083 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003084
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003085maxconn <conns>
3086 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3087 10 is the default.
3088
3089timeout client <timeout>
3090 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3091
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020030924. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003093----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003094
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003095Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02003096 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003097 - frontend <name>
3098 - backend <name>
3099 - listen <name>
3100
3101A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
3102its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
3103section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003104section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003105
3106A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3107connections.
3108
3109A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3110to forward incoming connections.
3111
3112A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3113parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3114
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003115All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3116'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3117case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3118
3119Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3120logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3121proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3122However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3123name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3124
3125Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3126and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003127bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003128protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3129modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3130arbitrary criteria.
3131
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003132In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3133a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003134the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003135
3136 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3137 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3138 between responses and new requests.
3139
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003140 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3141 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3142 client-facing connection remains open.
3143
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003144 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3145 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003146
3147The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3148frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3149following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003150weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003151
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003152 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003153
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003154 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3155 ----+-----+-----+----
3156 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3157 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003158 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3159 ----+-----+-----+----
3160 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003161
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003162
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031644.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3165--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003166
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003167The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3168limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3169they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3170limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003171marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003172option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003173and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3174with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3175specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003176
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003177
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003178 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3179------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3180acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003181backlog X X X -
3182balance X - X X
3183bind - X X -
3184bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003185capture cookie - X X -
3186capture request header - X X -
3187capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003188clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3189clitcpka-idle X X X -
3190clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003191compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003192cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003193declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003194default-server X - X X
3195default_backend X X X -
3196description - X X X
3197disabled X X X X
3198dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003199email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003200email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003201email-alert mailers X X X X
3202email-alert myhostname X X X X
3203email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003204enabled X X X X
3205errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003206errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003207errorloc X X X X
3208errorloc302 X X X X
3209-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3210errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003211force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003212filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003213fullconn X - X X
3214grace X X X X
3215hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003216http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003217http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003218http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003219http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003220http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003221http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003222http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003223http-check set-var X - X X
3224http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003225http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003226http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003227http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003228http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003229http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003230id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003231ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003232load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003233log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003234log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003235log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003236log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003237max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003238maxconn X X X -
3239mode X X X X
3240monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003241monitor-uri X X X -
3242option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3243option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3244option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3245option allbackups (*) X - X X
3246option checkcache (*) X - X X
3247option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3248option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003249option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003250option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3251option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003252-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3253option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003254option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3255option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003256option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003257option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003258option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003259option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003260option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003261option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3262option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3263option httpchk X - X X
3264option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003265option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003266option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003267option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003268option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003269option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003270option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3271option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3272option logasap (*) X X X -
3273option mysql-check X - X X
3274option nolinger (*) X X X X
3275option originalto X X X X
3276option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003277option pgsql-check X - X X
3278option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003279option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003280option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003281option smtpchk X - X X
3282option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3283option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3284option splice-request (*) X X X X
3285option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003286option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003287option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3288option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3289-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003290option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003291option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3292option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3293option tcpka X X X X
3294option tcplog X X X X
3295option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003296external-check command X - X X
3297external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003298persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3299rate-limit sessions X X X -
3300redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003301-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003302retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003303retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003304server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003305server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003306server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003307source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003308srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3309srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3310srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003311stats admin - X X X
3312stats auth X X X X
3313stats enable X X X X
3314stats hide-version X X X X
3315stats http-request - X X X
3316stats realm X X X X
3317stats refresh X X X X
3318stats scope X X X X
3319stats show-desc X X X X
3320stats show-legends X X X X
3321stats show-node X X X X
3322stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003323-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3324stick match - - X X
3325stick on - - X X
3326stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003327stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003328stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003329tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003330tcp-check connect X - X X
3331tcp-check expect X - X X
3332tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003333tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003334tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003335tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003336tcp-check set-var X - X X
3337tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003338tcp-request connection - X X -
3339tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003340tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003341tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003342tcp-response content - - X X
3343tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003344timeout check X - X X
3345timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003346timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003347timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003348timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3349timeout http-request X X X X
3350timeout queue X - X X
3351timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003352timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003353timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003354timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003355transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003356unique-id-format X X X -
3357unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003358use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003359use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003360use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003361------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3362 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003363
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003364
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033654.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3366---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003367
3368This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3369
3370
3371acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3372 Declare or complete an access list.
3373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3374 no | yes | yes | yes
3375 Example:
3376 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3377 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3378 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3379
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003380 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003381
3382
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003383backlog <conns>
3384 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3386 yes | yes | yes | no
3387 Arguments :
3388 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3389 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003390 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003391
3392 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3393 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3394 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3395 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3396 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3397 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3398 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3399 backlog parameter.
3400
3401 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3402 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3403 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3404
3405 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3406
3407
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003408balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003409balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003410 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3412 yes | no | yes | yes
3413 Arguments :
3414 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3415 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3416 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3417 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3418
3419 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3420 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3421 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3422 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003423 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003424 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003425 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3426 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3427 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3428 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3429 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3430 it, so that you don't worry.
3431
3432 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3433 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3434 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3435 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3436 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3437 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3438 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3439 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003440
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003441 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3442 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3443 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3444 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3445 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3446 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3447 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003448 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3449 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3450 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003451
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003452 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003453 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003454 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3455 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003456 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003457 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3458 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3459 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3460 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3461 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003462 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3463 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3464 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3465 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3466 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3467 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003468
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003469 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3470 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3471 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3472 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3473 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3474 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3475 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3476 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003477 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003478 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003479 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3480 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3481 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003482
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003483 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3484 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3485 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3486 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3487 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3488 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3489 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3490 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3491 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3492 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3493 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3494 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003495
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003496 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003497 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3498 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3499 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3500 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3501 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3502 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3503 URIs start with a leading "/".
3504
3505 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3506 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3507 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3508 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3509
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003510 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3511 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3512 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3513 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3514
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003515 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003516 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3517
3518 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003519 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3520 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003521 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3522 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3523 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3524 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003525 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003526 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3527 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003528
3529 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3530 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3531 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3532 server will receive the request.
3533
3534 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3535 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3536 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3537 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3538 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003539 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3540 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3541 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003542
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003543 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3544 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3545 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3546 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3547 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003548
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003549 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003550 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3551 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3552 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3553
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003554 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3555 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3556 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3557
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003558 random
3559 random(<draws>)
3560 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003561 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3562 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3563 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3564 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003565 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3566 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3567 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3568 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3569 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3570 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3571 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3572 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3573 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3574 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3575 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3576 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3577 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3578 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3579 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3580 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3581 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3582 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3583 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3584 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003585
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003586 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003587 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003588 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3589 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3590 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3591 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3592 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3593 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003594 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003595 used instead.
3596
3597 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3598 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3599 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3600 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3601
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003602 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3603 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3604 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3605
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003606 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003607
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003608 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003609 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3610 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003611
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003612 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3613 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3614 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003615
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003616 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003617 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003618 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3619 NTLM relies on.
3620
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003621 Examples :
3622 balance roundrobin
3623 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003624 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003625 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3626 balance hdr(host)
3627 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003628
3629 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3630 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3631
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003632 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003633 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3634 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3635 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003636 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003637
3638 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3639 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3640 defaults to 16 kB.
3641
3642 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3643 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3644
3645 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3646 Round Robin.
3647
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003648 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003649 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3650 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3651 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3652
3653 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3654
3655 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003656 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003657 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3658 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3659 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003660
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003661 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003662
3663
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003664bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3665bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003666 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3668 no | yes | yes | no
3669 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003670 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3671 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3672 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3673 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003674 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003675 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3676 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3677 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3678 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3679 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3680 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003681 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003682 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3683 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003684 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003685 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3686 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003687 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003688 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3689 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003690 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003691 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3692 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3693 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3694 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3695 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3696 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3697 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003698 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3699 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3700 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003701 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3702 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3703 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3704 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003705 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3706 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3707 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003708
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003709 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3710 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003711 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3712 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3713 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003714 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3715 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3716 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3717 the range.
3718
3719 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3720 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3721 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3722 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3723 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3724 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3725 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003726 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003727 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003728
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003729 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003730 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003731 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3732 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3733 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3734 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3735 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3736 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3737
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003738 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3739 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3740 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3741 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003742
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003743 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3744 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3745 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3746 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3747 in a frontend.
3748
3749 Example :
3750 listen http_proxy
3751 bind :80,:443
3752 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003753 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003754
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003755 listen http_https_proxy
3756 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003757 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003758
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003759 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3760 bind ipv6@:80
3761 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3762 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3763
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003764 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003765 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003766
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003767 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3768 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3769 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3770 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3771 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3772
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003773 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003774 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003775
3776
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003777bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003778 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3780 yes | yes | yes | yes
3781 Arguments :
3782 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3783 may be used to override a default value.
3784
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003785 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003786 option may be combined with other numbers.
3787
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003788 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003789 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3790 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3791 missing from all processes.
3792
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003793 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003794 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003795 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3796 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3797 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3798 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3799 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003800 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003801
3802 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3803 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3804 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3805 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3806 and 'even' instances.
3807
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003808 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3809 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3810 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3811 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003812
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003813 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3814 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3815
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003816 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3817 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3818 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3819
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003820 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3821 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3822
3823 Example :
3824 listen app_ip1
3825 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003826 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003827
3828 listen app_ip2
3829 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003830 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003831
3832 listen management
3833 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003834 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003835
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003836 listen management
3837 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3838 bind-process 1-4
3839
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003840 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003841
3842
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003843capture cookie <name> len <length>
3844 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3846 no | yes | yes | no
3847 Arguments :
3848 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3849 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3850 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3851 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003852 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003853
3854 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3855 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3856 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3857 right if it exceeds <length>.
3858
3859 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3860 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3861 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3862 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3863
3864 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3865 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3866 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3867
3868 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3869 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3870 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003871 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3872 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3873 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003874
3875 Example:
3876 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3877
3878 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003879 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003880
3881
3882capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003883 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3885 no | yes | yes | no
3886 Arguments :
3887 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003888 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003889 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3890 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3891 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3892
3893 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3894 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3895 it exceeds <length>.
3896
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003897 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003898 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3899 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003900 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3901 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3902 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3903 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003904 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003905 environments to find where the request came from.
3906
3907 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3908 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3909 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3910 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003911
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003912 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3913 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3914 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3915 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3916 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003917
3918 Example:
3919 capture request header Host len 15
3920 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003921 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003922
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003923 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003924 about logging.
3925
3926
3927capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003928 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3930 no | yes | yes | no
3931 Arguments :
3932 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003933 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003934 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3935 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3936 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3937
3938 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3939 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3940 it exceeds <length>.
3941
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003942 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003943 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3944 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3945 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003946 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3947 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3948 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3949 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003950
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003951 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3952 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3953 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3954 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3955 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003956
3957 Example:
3958 capture response header Content-length len 9
3959 capture response header Location len 15
3960
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003961 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003962 about logging.
3963
3964
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003965clitcpka-cnt <count>
3966 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
3967 the connection on the client side.
3968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3969 yes | yes | yes | no
3970 Arguments :
3971 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
3972
3973 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
3974 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003975 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3976 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003977
3978 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
3979
3980
3981clitcpka-idle <timeout>
3982 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
3983 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
3984 client side.
3985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3986 yes | yes | yes | no
3987 Arguments :
3988 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
3989 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
3990 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
3991 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
3992
3993 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
3994 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003995 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3996 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003997
3998 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
3999
4000
4001clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4002 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4004 yes | yes | yes | no
4005 Arguments :
4006 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4007 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4008 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4009 document.
4010
4011 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4012 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004013 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4014 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004015
4016 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4017
4018
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004019compression algo <algorithm> ...
4020compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004021compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004022 Enable HTTP compression.
4023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4024 yes | yes | yes | yes
4025 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004026 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4027 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4028 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4029
4030 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004031 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4032 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4033 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004034
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004035 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004036 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004037
4038 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4039 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4040 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4041 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4042 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004043 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004044
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004045 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4046 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4047 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4048 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4049 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4050 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4051 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004052 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004053
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004054 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004055 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004056 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4057 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4058 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4059 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4060 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004061
4062 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4063 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4064 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4065 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4066 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004067 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4068 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4069 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4070 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4071 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004072 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4073 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004074
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004075 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004076 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4077 "Accept-Encoding" header
4078 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004079 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004080 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4081 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4082 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4083 "multipart"
4084 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4085 header
4086 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4087 and later
4088 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4089 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004090 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004091
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004092 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004093
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004094 Examples :
4095 compression algo gzip
4096 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004097
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004098
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004099cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004100 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4101 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004102 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004103 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4105 yes | no | yes | yes
4106 Arguments :
4107 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4108 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4109 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4110 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4111 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4112 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004113 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004114 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4115 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4116
4117 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4118 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4119 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4120 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4121 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4122 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004123 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4124 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004125 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004126 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4127 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004128
4129 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004130 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004131
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004132 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004133 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004134 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004135 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004136 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4137 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4138 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4139 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4140 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4141 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4142 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004143
4144 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4145 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4146 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4147 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4148 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4149 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4150 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4151 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4152 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004153 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004154 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4155 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4156 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004157
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004158 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4159 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4160 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004161 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4162 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4163 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4164 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004165 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4166 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4167 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004168
4169 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4170 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4171 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4172 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4173 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4174 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4175 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4176 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4177 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4178
4179 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4180 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4181 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4182 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4183 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4184 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4185 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4186 persistence cookie in the cache.
4187 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4188
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004189 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4190 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4191 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4192 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4193 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004194 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004195 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4196 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4197 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4198 they logout.
4199
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004200 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4201 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4202 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4203 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4204
4205 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4206 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4207 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4208 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4209 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4210 this attribute.
4211
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004212 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004213 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004214 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4215 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4216 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4217 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4218 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4219 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004220
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004221 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4222 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4223 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4224 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4225 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4226 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4227 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4228 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004229 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004230 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4231 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4232 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4233 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4234 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4235 the site.
4236
4237 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4238 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4239 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4240 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4241 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4242 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4243 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4244 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4245 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4246 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4247 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4248 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4249 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004250 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004251 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4252 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4253
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004254 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4255 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4256 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4257 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4258 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4259 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4260
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004261 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4262 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4263 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4264 repeated.
4265
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004266 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4267 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4268 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4269 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004270
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004271 Examples :
4272 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4273 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4274 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004275 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004276
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004277 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004278
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004279
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004280declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4281 Declares a capture slot.
4282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4283 no | yes | yes | no
4284 Arguments:
4285 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4286
4287 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4288 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4289 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4290 for use in the response.
4291
4292 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004293 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004294 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4295
4296
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004297default-server [param*]
4298 Change default options for a server in a backend
4299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4300 yes | no | yes | yes
4301 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004302 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4303 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4304 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4305 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004306
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004307 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004308 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4309
4310 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004311
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004312
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004313default_backend <backend>
4314 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4316 yes | yes | yes | no
4317 Arguments :
4318 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4319
4320 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4321 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4322 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4323 will catch all undetermined requests.
4324
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004325 Example :
4326
4327 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4328 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4329 default_backend dynamic
4330
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004331 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004332
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004333
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004334description <string>
4335 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4337 no | yes | yes | yes
4338 Arguments : string
4339
4340 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4341 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4342 it describes.
4343 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4344
4345
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004346disabled
4347 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4349 yes | yes | yes | yes
4350 Arguments : none
4351
4352 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4353 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4354 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4355 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4356 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4357 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4358 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4359
4360 See also : "enabled"
4361
4362
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004363dispatch <address>:<port>
4364 Set a default server address
4365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4366 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004367 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004368
4369 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4370 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4371 during start-up.
4372
4373 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4374 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4375 possible with normal servers.
4376
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004377 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004378 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4379 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4380 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4381 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4382
4383 See also : "server"
4384
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004385
4386dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4387 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4389 yes | no | yes | yes
4390 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4391
4392 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004393 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004394 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4395 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004396 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004397 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004398
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004399enabled
4400 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4402 yes | yes | yes | yes
4403 Arguments : none
4404
4405 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4406 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4407
4408 See also : "disabled"
4409
4410
4411errorfile <code> <file>
4412 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4414 yes | yes | yes | yes
4415 Arguments :
4416 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004417 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004418 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004419
4420 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004421 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004422 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004423 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4424 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004425
4426 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4427 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4428 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4429
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004430 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4431
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004432 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4433 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4434 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4435 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4436 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4437 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4438 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4439 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4440 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004441
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004442 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4443 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4444 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004445 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004446 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4447
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004448 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004449
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004450 Example :
4451 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004452 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004453 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4454 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4455
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004456
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004457errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4458 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4459 section.
4460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4461 yes | yes | yes | yes
4462 Arguments :
4463 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4464
4465 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004466 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004467 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004468
4469 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4470 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4471 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4472 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4473 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004474 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004475 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4476
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004477 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4478 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004479
4480 Example :
4481 errorfiles generic
4482 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4483
4484
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004485errorloc <code> <url>
4486errorloc302 <code> <url>
4487 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4489 yes | yes | yes | yes
4490 Arguments :
4491 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004492 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004493 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004494
4495 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4496 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4497 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4498 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004499 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004500
4501 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4502 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4503 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4504
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004505 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4506
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004507 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4508 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4509 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4510 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004511 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004512 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4513 request.
4514
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004515 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004516
4517
4518errorloc303 <code> <url>
4519 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4521 yes | yes | yes | yes
4522 Arguments :
4523 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004524 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004525 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004526
4527 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4528 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4529 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4530 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004531 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004532
4533 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4534 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4535 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4536
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004537 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4538
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004539 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4540 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4541 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4542 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004543 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004544
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004545 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004546
4547
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004548email-alert from <emailaddr>
4549 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004550 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004551 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4552 yes | yes | yes | yes
4553
4554 Arguments :
4555
4556 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4557
4558 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4559 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4560
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004561 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004562 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4563 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004564
4565
4566email-alert level <level>
4567 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4568 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4569 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4570 yes | yes | yes | yes
4571
4572 Arguments :
4573
4574 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4575 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4576 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4577
4578 By default level is alert
4579
4580 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4581 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4582 for the proxy.
4583
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004584 Alerts are sent when :
4585
4586 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4587 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4588 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4589 is notice or lower
4590 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4591 and a health check status update occurs
4592
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004593 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4594 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004595 section 3.6 about mailers.
4596
4597
4598email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4599 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4600 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4601 yes | yes | yes | yes
4602
4603 Arguments :
4604
4605 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4606
4607 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4608 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4609
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004610 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4611 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004612
4613
4614email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4615 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4616 mailers.
4617 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4618 yes | yes | yes | yes
4619
4620 Arguments :
4621
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004622 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004623
4624 By default the systems hostname is used.
4625
4626 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4627 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4628 for the proxy.
4629
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004630 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4631 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004632
4633
4634email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004635 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004636 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4637 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4638 yes | yes | yes | yes
4639
4640 Arguments :
4641
4642 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4643
4644 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4645 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4646
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004647 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004648 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4649
4650
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004651force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4652 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4653 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004654 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004655
4656 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4657 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4658 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4659 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4660 marked down for maintenance operations.
4661
4662 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4663 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4664 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4665 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4666 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4667 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4668 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4669 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4670 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4671
4672 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4673 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4674 is used.
4675
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004676 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004677 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004678
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004679
4680filter <name> [param*]
4681 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4683 no | yes | yes | yes
4684 Arguments :
4685 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4686 referenced in section 9.
4687
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004688 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004689 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004690 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4691 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004692
4693 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4694 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4695
4696 Example:
4697 listen
4698 bind *:80
4699
4700 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4701 filter compression
4702 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4703
4704 compression algo gzip
4705 compression offload
4706
4707 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4708
4709 See also : section 9.
4710
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004711
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004712fullconn <conns>
4713 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4715 yes | no | yes | yes
4716 Arguments :
4717 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4718 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4719
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004720 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004721 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004722 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004723 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4724 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4725 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4726 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4727 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004728 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004729
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004730 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4731 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004732 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4733 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4734 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004735
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004736 Example :
4737 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4738 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4739 # connections.
4740 backend dynamic
4741 fullconn 10000
4742 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4743 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4744
4745 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4746
4747
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004748grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004749 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004751 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004752 Arguments :
4753 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4754 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4755 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4756
4757 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4758 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004759 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004760 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4761
4762 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4763 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4764 simplify it.
4765
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004766
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004767hash-balance-factor <factor>
4768 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4770 yes | no | no | yes
4771 Arguments :
4772 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4773 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004774 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004775
4776 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4777 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4778 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4779 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4780 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4781 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4782 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4783
4784 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4785 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4786 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4787 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4788 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4789
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004790 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4791 consistent hashing mechanism.
4792
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004793 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4794
4795
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004796hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004797 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4799 yes | no | yes | yes
4800 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004801 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4802 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004803
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004804 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4805 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4806 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4807 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4808 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4809 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4810 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4811 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4812 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4813 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004814
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004815 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4816 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4817 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4818 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4819 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4820 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4821 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4822 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4823 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4824 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4825 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4826 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4827 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004828 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4829 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004830
4831 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4832
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004833 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004834 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4835 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4836 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004837 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4838 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4839 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004840
4841 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4842 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004843 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4844 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4845 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4846 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4847
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004848 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4849 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4850 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4851 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4852 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4853 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4854 parameter.
4855
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004856 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4857 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4858 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4859 used on strings.
4860
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004861 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4862
4863 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4864 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4865 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4866 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4867 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4868 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4869 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4870 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4871 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4872 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4873 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4874 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004875
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004876 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4877 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4878 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004879
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004880 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004881
4882
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004883http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4884 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4885 ones).
4886
4887 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4888 no | yes | yes | yes
4889
4890 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4891 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4892 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4893 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4894 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4895 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4896
4897 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4898 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4899 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4900
4901 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4902 below.
4903
4904 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4905 instance.
4906
4907 Example:
4908 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4909 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4910 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4911
4912http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4913
4914 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4915 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4916 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4917 example, or to pass some internal information.
4918 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4919 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4920 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4921
4922http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4923
4924 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4925 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4926
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004927http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004928
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004929 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
4930 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
4931 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
4932 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
4933 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004934
4935http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4936 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4937
4938 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4939
4940 Example:
4941 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4942
4943 # applied to:
4944 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4945
4946 # outputs:
4947 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4948
4949 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4950
4951http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4952 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4953
4954 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4955
4956 Example:
4957 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4958
4959 # applied to:
4960 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4961
4962 # outputs:
4963 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4964
4965http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4966
4967 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4968 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4969 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4970
4971http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4972 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4973
4974 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4975 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4976 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4977 fallback.
4978
4979 Example:
4980 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4981 http-response set-status 431
4982 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4983 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4984
4985http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4986
4987 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4988 inline.
4989
4990 Arguments:
4991 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4992 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4993 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4994 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4995 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4996 (request and response)
4997 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4998 processing
4999 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5000 processing
5001 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5002 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5003 and '_'.
5004
5005 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5006 followed by some converters.
5007
5008 Example:
5009 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5010
5011http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5012
5013 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5014 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5015 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5016 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5017 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005018 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005019 processing.
5020
5021 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5022 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005023 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005024 rules evaluation.
5025
5026http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5027
5028 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5029 details about <var-name>.
5030
5031 Example:
5032 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5033
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005034
5035http-check comment <string>
5036 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5037 it fails.
5038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5039 yes | no | yes | yes
5040
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005041 Arguments :
5042 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5043 rule fails.
5044
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005045 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5046 user-friendly error reporting.
5047
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005048 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005049 "http-check expect".
5050
5051
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005052http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5053 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005054 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005055 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5057 yes | no | yes | yes
5058
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005059 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005060 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5061
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005062 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005063 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005064
5065 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5066 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5067 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5068 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5069
5070 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5071
5072 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5073
5074 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5075
5076 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5077
5078 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5079
5080 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5081 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5082 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5083 is used.
5084
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005085 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5086 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5087 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5088 haproxy -vv.
5089
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005090 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5091
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005092 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5093 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5094 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5095 different ports or with different servers.
5096
5097 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5098 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5099 the port with a "http-check connect".
5100
5101 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5102 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5103 do.
5104
5105 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5106 unset-var or comment rules.
5107
5108 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005109 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5110 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5111 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5112 option httpchk
5113
5114 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005115 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005116 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005117 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005118 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005119 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005120
5121 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5122
5123 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005124
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005125
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005126http-check disable-on-404
5127 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005129 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005130 Arguments : none
5131
5132 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5133 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5134 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5135 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5136 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5137 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5138 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5139 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005140 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5141 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
5142 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
5143
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005144 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005145
5146
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005147http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005148 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5149 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5150 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005151 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005153 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005154
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005155 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005156 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5157
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005158 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5159 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5160 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5161 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5162 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5163 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5164 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5165 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5166 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5167 result is always conclusive.
5168
5169 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5170 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5171 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005172 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5173 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
5174 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
5175 example 404 with disable-on-404
5176 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5177 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5178 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005179
5180 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5181 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005182 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
5183 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5184 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5185 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5186 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5187 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005188
5189 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5190 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005191 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5192 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5193 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5194 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005195 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5196
5197 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5198 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5199 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5200 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5201
5202 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5203 informational message reported in logs if an error
5204 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5205 log-format string.
5206
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005207 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005208 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5209 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005210 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5211 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5212 details on the supported keywords.
5213
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005214 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5215 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5216 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5217 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005218
5219 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5220 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5221 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5222 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5223 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5224
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005225 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5226 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5227 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5228 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5229 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5230 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5231 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005232
5233 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005234 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005235 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5236 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5237 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5238 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5239
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005240 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5241 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005242 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5243 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5244 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5245 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5246 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5247 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5248 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5249 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005250 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5251 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5252 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5253 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5254 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5255 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5256 insensitive on the header names.
5257
5258 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5259 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5260 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5261 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5262 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5263 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005264
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005265 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005266 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005267 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5268 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5269 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5270 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5271 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005272 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005273 trace).
5274
5275 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005276 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005277 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5278 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5279 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5280 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5281 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005282 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005283
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005284 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5285 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5286 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5287 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5288 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5289 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5290
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005291 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Faulet7151a122020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005292 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005293 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5294 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5295 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5296 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5297 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5298 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5299
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005300 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5301 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5302 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5303 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5304 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005305
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005306 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5307 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5308
5309 Examples :
5310 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005311 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005312
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005313 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5314 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5315
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005316 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005317 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005318
5319 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005320 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005321
5322 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005323 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005324
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005325 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005326 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005327
5328
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005329http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005330 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5331 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005332 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5333 health checks.
5334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5335 yes | no | yes | yes
5336 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005337 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5338
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005339 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5340 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5341 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5342 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5343 to invent non-standard ones.
5344
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005345 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5346 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5347 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5348 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5349
5350 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5351 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5352 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5353 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005354
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005355 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005356 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005357 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005358 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5359 to add it.
5360
5361 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5362 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5363 to the log-format rules.
5364
5365 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5366 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5367 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005368
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005369 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5370 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5371 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5372 request.
5373
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005374 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5375 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5376 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005377 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5378 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5379 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5380 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelleaea63022020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005381 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005382
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005383 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelleaea63022020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005384 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5385 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005386
5387 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5388 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5389 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5390 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5391 configured request authority.
5392
5393 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5394 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005395
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005396 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005397
5398
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005399http-check send-state
5400 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5402 yes | no | yes | yes
5403 Arguments : none
5404
5405 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5406 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5407 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5408 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5409 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5410
5411 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5412 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5413 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5414 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5415 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005416 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5417 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5418 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5419
5420 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5421 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5422 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5423
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005424 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5425 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5426 checked in multiple backends.
5427
5428 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5429 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5430
5431 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5432 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5433 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5434 one fails.
5435
5436 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5437 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5438 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5439
5440 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5441 server's queue.
5442
5443 Example of a header received by the application server :
5444 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5445 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5446
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005447 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5448 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005449
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005450
5451http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005452 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005453 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5454 yes | no | yes | yes
5455
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005456 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005457 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5458 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5459 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5460 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5461 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5462 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5463 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5464 and '-'.
5465
5466 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5467
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005468 Examples :
5469 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005470
5471
5472http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005473 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005474 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5475 yes | no | yes | yes
5476
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005477 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005478 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5479 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5480 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5481 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5482 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5483 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5484 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5485 and '-'.
5486
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005487 Examples :
5488 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005489
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005490
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005491http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5492 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5493 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5494 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5495 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5497 yes | yes | yes | yes
5498 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005499 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005500 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005501 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5502 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005503
5504 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5505 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5506 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5507 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5508
5509 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5510 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5511 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5512 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5513
5514 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5515 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5516 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5517 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5518 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5519 chroot is performed.
5520
5521 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5522 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5523 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5524 considered.
5525
5526 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5527 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5528 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5529 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5530 considered as a raw string.
5531
5532 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5533 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5534 "content-type".
5535
5536 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5537 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5538 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5539 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5540 evaluated as a log-format string.
5541
5542 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5543 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5544 argument to "content-type".
5545
5546 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5547 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5548 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5549 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5550
5551 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5552 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5553 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5554 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5555 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5556 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5557 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5558 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5559
5560 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5561 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5562 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5563
5564 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5565 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5566
5567
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005568http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005569 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5570
5571 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5572 no | yes | yes | yes
5573
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005574 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5575 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5576 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5577 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5578 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005579
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005580 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5581 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005582
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005583 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005584
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005585 Example:
5586 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5587 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5588 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005589
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005590 http-request allow if nagios
5591 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5592 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5593 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005594
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005595 Example:
5596 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5597 acl add path /addacl
5598 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005599
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005600 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005601
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005602 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5603 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005604
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005605 Example:
5606 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5607 acl setmap path /setmap
5608 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005609
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005610 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005612 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5613 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005614
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005615 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5616 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005617
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005618http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005620 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5621 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5622 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5623 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5624 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5625 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5626 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5627 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005629http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005630
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005631 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5632 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5633 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5634 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5635 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5636 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5637 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5638 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005639
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005640http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005641
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005642 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5643 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005644
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005645
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005646http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005647
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005648 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5649 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5650 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5651 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5652 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005653
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005654 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5655 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5656 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5657 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5658 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5659 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5660 instead.
5661
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005662 Example:
5663 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5664 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005665
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005666http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005667
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005668 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005669
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005670http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5671 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005672
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005673 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5674 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5675 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5676 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5677 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5678 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5679 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5680 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5681 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005682
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005683 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5684 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5685 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005686 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5687
5688 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5689 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5690 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5691 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005692
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005693http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005694
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005695 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5696 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5697 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5698 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5699 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5700 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005701
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005702http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005703
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005704 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5705 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5706 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5707 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5708 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005709
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005710http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005711
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005712 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5713 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5714 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5715 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5716 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5717 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005718
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005719http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5720http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5721 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5722 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5723 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5724 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005725
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005726 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5727 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5728 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005729 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005730 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5731 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5732 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005733 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005734 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005735
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005736http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5737 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5738 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5739 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5740
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005741http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5742
5743 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5744 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5745 pointed by <resolvers>.
5746 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5747 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5748 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5749 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5750 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5751 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5752 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5753 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5754 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5755 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5756 to 0.0.0.0.
5757
5758 Example:
5759 resolvers mydns
5760 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5761 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5762 timeout retry 1s
5763 hold valid 10s
5764 hold nx 3s
5765 hold other 3s
5766 hold obsolete 0s
5767 accepted_payload_size 8192
5768
5769 frontend fe
5770 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5771 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5772 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5773
5774 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5775 # which mean DNS resolution error
5776 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5777
5778 default_backend be
5779
5780 backend b_503
5781 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5782 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5783 # 503 error page to end users
5784
5785 backend be
5786 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5787 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5788 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5789 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5790 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5791
5792 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5793 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5794
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005795http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5796
5797 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5798 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5799 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5800 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005801 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5802 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005803
5804 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5805
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005806http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005807
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005808 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5809 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5810 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5811 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5812 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005813
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005814http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005815
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005816 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5817 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5818 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5819 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005820
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005821http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5822 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005823
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005824 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005825 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5826 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5827 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5828 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5829 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005830
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005831 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5832 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5833 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5834 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5835 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005836
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005837 Example:
5838 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5839
5840 # applied to:
5841 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5842
5843 # outputs:
5844 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5845
5846 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005847
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005848 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5849
5850 # applied to:
5851 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005852
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005853 # outputs:
5854 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005855
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005856http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5857 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5858
5859 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5860 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02005861 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
5862 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
5863 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005864
5865 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5866 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5867 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5868
5869 Example:
5870 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5871 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5872
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005873 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5874 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5875 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5876 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5877
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005878http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5879 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5880
5881 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
5882 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
5883 query-string are replaced.
5884
5885 Example:
5886 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5887 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5888
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005889http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5890 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5891
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005892 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5893 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5894 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5895 against.
5896
5897 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5898 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5899 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005900
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005901 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5902 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5903 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5904 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5905 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5906 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5907 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5908 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5909 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005910 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5911 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005912
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005913 Example:
5914 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5915 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005916
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005917 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5918 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005919
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005920http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5921 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005922
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005923 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5924 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5925 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5926 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005927
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005928 Example:
5929 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005930
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005931 # applied to:
5932 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005933
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005934 # outputs:
5935 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005936
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005937http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5938 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5939 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005940 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005941 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5942
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005943 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005944 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5945 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005946 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005947 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005948 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005949 are followed to create the response :
5950
5951 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5952 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5953 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5954 ignored.
5955
5956 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5957 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005958 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005959 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5960 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005961
5962 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5963 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5964 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005965 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005966 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005967
5968 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5969 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5970 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005971 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005972 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5973 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005974
5975 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5976 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5977 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5978 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5979 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5980 as a raw content.
5981
5982 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5983 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5984 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5985 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5986 considered as a raw string.
5987
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005988 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005989 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5990 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5991 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5992
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005993 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5994 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005995 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005996
5997 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5998
5999 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006000 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006001 if { path /ping }
6002
6003 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6004 if { path /favicon.ico }
6005
6006 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6007 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6008 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6009
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006010http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6011http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006012
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006013 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6014 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6015 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006016
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006017http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6018 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006019
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006020 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6021 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6022 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6023 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006024
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006025http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006026
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006027 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6028 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6029 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6030 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6031 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006032
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006033 Arguments:
6034 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6035 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006036
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006037 Example:
6038 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6039 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006040
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006041 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6042 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006043
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006044http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006045
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006046 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6047 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6048 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006049
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006050 Arguments:
6051 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6052 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006053
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006054 Example:
6055 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6056 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006057
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006058 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6059 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6060 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006061
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006062http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006063
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006064 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6065 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6066 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6067 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6068 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006069
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006070 Example:
6071 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6072 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6073 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6074 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6075 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6076 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6077 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6078 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6079 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006080
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006081http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006082
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006083 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6084 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6085 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6086 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6087 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006088
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006089http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6090 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006091
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006092 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6093 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6094 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6095 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6096 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6097 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6098 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6099 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6100 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006101
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006102http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006103
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006104 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6105 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6106 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6107 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6108 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6109 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6110 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006111
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006112http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006113
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006114 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6115 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6116 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006117
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006118http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006119
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006120 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6121 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6122 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6123 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6124 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6125 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6126 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6127 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006128
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006129http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006130
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006131 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6132 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6133 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6134 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6135 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6136 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006137
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006138 Example :
6139 # prepend the host name before the path
6140 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006141
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006142http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6143
6144 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6145 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6146 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6147
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006148http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006149
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006150 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6151 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6152 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6153 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6154 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006155
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006156http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006157
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006158 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6159 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6160 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6161 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6162 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6163 values have higher priority.
6164 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6165 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6166 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6167 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6168 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006169
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006170http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006171
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006172 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6173 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6174 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6175 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6176 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6177 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6178 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006179
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006180 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006181
6182 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006183 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6184 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006185
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006186http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6187 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6188 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6189 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006190 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6191 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006192
6193 Arguments :
6194 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6195 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006196
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006197 See also "option forwardfor".
6198
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006199 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006200 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6201 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6202
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006203 # After the masking this will track connections
6204 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6205 http-request track-sc0 src
6206
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006207 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6208 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6209
6210http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6211
6212 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6213 expression.
6214
6215 Arguments:
6216 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6217 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006218
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006219 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006220 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6221 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6222
6223 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6224 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6225 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6226
6227http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6228
6229 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6230 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6231 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6232 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6233 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6234 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6235 information from the request.
6236
6237 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6238
6239http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6240
6241 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6242 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6243 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6244 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6245 path and the query string.
6246 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6247
6248http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6249
6250 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6251 inline.
6252
6253 Arguments:
6254 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6255 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6256 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6257 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6258 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6259 (request and response)
6260 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6261 processing
6262 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6263 processing
6264 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6265 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6266 and '_'.
6267
6268 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6269 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006270
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006271 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006272 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006273
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006274http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6275 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006276
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006277 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6278 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6279 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6280 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6281 agent name must be used.
6282
6283 Arguments:
6284 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6285
6286 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6287 configuration.
6288
6289http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6290
6291 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6292 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6293 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6294 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6295 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6296 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6297 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6298 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6299 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6300 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6301 action.
6302 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6303 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6304 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6305 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6306 you fully understand how it works.
6307
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006308http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6309
6310 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6311 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6312 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6313 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6314 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006315 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006316 processing.
6317
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006318 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006319 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6320 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6321 rules evaluation.
6322
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006323http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6324http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6325 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6326 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6327 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6328 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006329
6330 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6331 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6332 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006333 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6334 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6335 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6336 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6337 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6338 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6339 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6340 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6341 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6342 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006343 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006344 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6345 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6346 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6347 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6348 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006349
6350http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6351http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6352http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6353
6354 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6355 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6356 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6357 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006358 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006359 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6360 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6361 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6362 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6363 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6364 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6365 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6366
6367 Arguments :
6368 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6369 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6370 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6371 select which table entry to update the counters.
6372
6373 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6374 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6375 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6376 that table until the session ends.
6377
6378 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6379 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6380 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6381 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6382 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6383 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6384 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6385 useful information.
6386
6387 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6388 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6389 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6390 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6391 checks that make use of it.
6392
6393http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6394
6395 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006396
6397 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006398 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006399
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006400http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6401
6402 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6403 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6404 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6405 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6406 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6407 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6408
6409 Arguments :
6410 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6411
6412 Example:
6413 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6414
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006415http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006416
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006417 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6418 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6419 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006420
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006421
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006422http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006423 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6424
6425 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6426 no | yes | yes | yes
6427
6428 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6429 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6430 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6431 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6432 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6433 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6434
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006435 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6436 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006437
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006438 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006439
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006440 Example:
6441 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006442
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006443 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006444
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006445 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6446 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006447
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006448 Example:
6449 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006450
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006451 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006452
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006453 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6454 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006455
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006456 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6457 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006458
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006459http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006460
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006461 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6462 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6463 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6464 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6465 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6466 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6467 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6468 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006469
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006470http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006471
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006472 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6473 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6474 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6475 example, or to pass some internal information.
6476 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6477 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6478 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006479
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006480http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006481
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006482 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6483 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006484
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006485http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006486
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006487 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006488
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006489http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006490
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006491 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6492 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6493 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6494 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6495 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6496 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6497 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006498
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006499 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6500 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6501 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6502 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6503 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006504
6505 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6506 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6507 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6508 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006509
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006510http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006511
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006512 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6513 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6514 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6515 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6516 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6517 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006518
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006519http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006520
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006521 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6522 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6523 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6524 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6525 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006526
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006527http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006528
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006529 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6530 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6531 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6532 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6533 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6534 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006535
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006536http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6537http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6538 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6539 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6540 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6541 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006542
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006543 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6544 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6545 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006546 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006547 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6548 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6549 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006550 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006551 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006552
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006553http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006554
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006555 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6556 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6557 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6558 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6559 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6560 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006561
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006562http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6563 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006564
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006565 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6566 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006567
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006568 Example:
6569 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006570
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006571 # applied to:
6572 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006573
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006574 # outputs:
6575 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006576
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006577 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006578
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006579http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6580 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006581
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006582 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006583 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006584
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006585 Example:
6586 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006587
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006588 # applied to:
6589 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006590
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006591 # outputs:
6592 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006593
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006594http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6595 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6596 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006597 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006598 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6599
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006600 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006601 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6602 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006603 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006604 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006605 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006606 are followed to create the response :
6607
6608 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6609 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6610 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6611 ignored.
6612
6613 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6614 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006615 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006616 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6617 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006618
6619 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6620 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6621 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006622 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006623 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006624
6625 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6626 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6627 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006628 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006629 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6630 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006631
6632 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6633 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6634 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6635 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6636 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6637 as a raw content.
6638
6639 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6640 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6641 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6642 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6643 considered as a raw string.
6644
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006645 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6646 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6647 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6648 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6649
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006650 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6651 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006652 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006653
6654 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6655
6656 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006657 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006658 if { status eq 404 }
6659
6660 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6661 string "This is the end !" \
6662 if { status eq 500 }
6663
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006664http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6665http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006666
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006667 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6668 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6669 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006670
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006671http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6672 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006673
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006674 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6675 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6676 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6677 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006678
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006679http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006680
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006681 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6682 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6683 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6684 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6685 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006686
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006687 Arguments:
6688 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006689
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006690 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6691 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006692
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006693http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006694
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006695 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6696 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6697 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006698
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006699http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6700
6701 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6702 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6703 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6704 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6705 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6706
6707http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6708
6709 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6710 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6711 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6712 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6713 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6714 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6715 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6716 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6717 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6718
6719http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6720
6721 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6722 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6723 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6724 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6725 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6726 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6727 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6728
6729http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6730
6731 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6732 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6733 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6734 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6735 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6736 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6737 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6738 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6739
6740http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6741 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6742
6743 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6744 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6745 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6746 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006747
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006748 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006749 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6750 http-response set-status 431
6751 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6752 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006753
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006754http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006755
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006756 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6757 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6758 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6759 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6760 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6761 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6762 based on some information from the request.
6763
6764 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6765
6766http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6767
6768 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6769 inline.
6770
6771 Arguments:
6772 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6773 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6774 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6775 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6776 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6777 (request and response)
6778 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6779 processing
6780 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6781 processing
6782 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6783 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6784 and '_'.
6785
6786 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6787 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006788
6789 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006790 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006791
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006792http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006793
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006794 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6795 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6796 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6797 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6798 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6799 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6800 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6801 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6802 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6803 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6804 action.
6805 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6806 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6807 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6808 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6809 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006810
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006811http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6812
6813 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6814 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6815 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6816 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6817 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006818 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006819 processing.
6820
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006821 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006822 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006823 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006824 rules evaluation.
6825
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006826http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6827http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6828http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006829
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006830 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6831 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6832 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6833 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6834 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6835 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6836
6837http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6838
6839 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6840 about <var-name>.
6841
6842 Example:
6843 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6844
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006845
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006846http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6847 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6848
6849 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6850 yes | no | yes | yes
6851
6852 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006853 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6854 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6855 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006856
6857 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6858
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006859 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6860 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6861 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6862 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6863 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6864 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6865 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6866 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6867 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6868 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006869
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006870 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6871 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6872 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6873 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6874 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6875 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6876 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02006877 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
6878 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
6879 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
6880 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
6881 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
6882 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006883
6884 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6885 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6886 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6887 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6888 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6889 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6890 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6891 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006892 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006893 downsides of rare connection failures.
6894
6895 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6896 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6897 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6898 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6899 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6900 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006901 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006902 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6903 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6904 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6905 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6906 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6907
6908 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006909 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6910 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6911 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006912
Amaury Denoyelle7239c242020-10-15 16:41:09 +02006913 - connections sent to a server with a variable value as TLS SNI extension
6914 are marked private and are never shared. This is not the case if the SNI
6915 is guaranteed to be a constant, as for example using a literal string;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006916
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006917 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6918 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006919
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006920 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006921
6922 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6923 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6924 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6925
6926 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6927
6928
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006929http-send-name-header [<header>]
6930 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006931 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6932 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006933 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006934 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6935
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006936 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6937 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6938 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6939 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6940 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6941 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6942 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6943 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6944 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6945 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6946 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6947 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6948 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6949 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6950 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6951 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006952
6953 See also : "server"
6954
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006955id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006956 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6958 no | yes | yes | yes
6959 Arguments : none
6960
6961 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6962 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6963 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006964
6965
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006966ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6967 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6968 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006969 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006970
6971 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6972 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6973 and running).
6974
6975 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6976 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6977 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006978 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006979 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6980
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006981 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6982 "unless" condition is met.
6983
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006984 Example:
6985 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6986 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6987 ignore-persist if url_static
6988
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006989 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6990
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006991load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6992 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6993 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6994 yes | no | yes | yes
6995
6996 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6997 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6998 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006999 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007000 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7001 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7002 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7003 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7004
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007005 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007006 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007007 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007008
7009 Arguments:
7010 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7011 named "server-state-file".
7012
7013 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7014 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7015 name is used as a file name.
7016
7017 none don't load any stat for this backend
7018
7019 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007020 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7021 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7022 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007023 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007024 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007025
7026 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7027 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7028
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007029 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007030
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007031 global
7032 stats socket /tmp/socket
7033 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007034
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007035 defaults
7036 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007037
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007038 backend bk
7039 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7040 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007041
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007042
7043 Then one can run :
7044
7045 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7046
7047 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7048
7049 1
7050 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7051 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7052 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7053
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007054 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007055
7056 global
7057 stats socket /tmp/socket
7058 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7059
7060 defaults
7061 load-server-state-from-file local
7062
7063 backend bk
7064 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7065 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7066
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007067
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007068 Then one can run :
7069
7070 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7071
7072 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7073
7074 1
7075 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7076 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7077 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7078
7079 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7080 "show servers state"
7081
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007082
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007083log global
Jan Wagnerf2f5c4e2020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007084log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007085 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007086no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007087 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7089 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007090
7091 Prefix :
7092 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7093 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7094 prefix does not allow arguments.
7095
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007096 Arguments :
7097 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7098 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7099 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7100 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7101 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7102 parameter.
7103
7104 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7105 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7106
7107 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7108 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7109 standard syslog port).
7110
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007111 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7112 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7113 standard syslog port).
7114
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007115 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7116 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7117 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007118 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007119
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007120 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7121 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7122 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7123 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7124 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7125 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7126 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7127 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7128 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7129 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7130 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7131 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7132 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7133 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7134 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7135 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007136 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7137 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007138
7139 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7140 and "fd@2", see above.
7141
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007142 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7143 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7144 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7145 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7146 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7147 having the logs instantly available.
7148
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007149 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7150 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007151
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007152 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7153 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7154 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7155 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7156 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7157 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7158 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7159 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7160 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7161 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007162 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007163
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007164 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7165 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7166 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7167 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7168 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7169
7170 <sample_size>
7171 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7172 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7173 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7174 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7175 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7176
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007177 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7178 one of the following :
7179
Emeric Bruna0338b92020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007180 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7181 field is stripped. This is the default.
7182 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7183 rfc3164.
7184
7185 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007186 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7187
7188 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7189 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7190
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007191 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7192 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7193 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7194 designed to be used with a local log server.
7195
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007196 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7197 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7198 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7199 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7200 systemd logger consumes.
7201
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007202 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7203 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7204 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7205 used with a local log server.
7206
7207 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7208 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7209 designed to be used with a local log server.
7210
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007211 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7212 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7213 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7214 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7215
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007216 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7217
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007218 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7219 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7220 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7221
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007222 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7223 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7224 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7225 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007226
7227 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7228 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7229 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007230 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7231 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7232 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7233 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7234 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007235
7236 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7237
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007238 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7239 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7240 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007241
7242 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7243 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7244 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7245 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7246
7247 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7248 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007249
7250 Example :
7251 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007252 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7253 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7254 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007255 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
7256 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007257 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007258
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007259
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007260log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007261 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7262 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7263 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007264
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007265 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7266 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7267 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7268 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7269 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007270
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007271 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7272 "option httplog" directives.
7273
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007274log-format-sd <string>
7275 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7276 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7277 yes | yes | yes | no
7278
7279 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7280 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7281 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7282 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7283 which covers the log format string in depth.
7284
7285 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7286 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7287
7288 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7289 log format to "rfc5424".
7290
7291 Example :
7292 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7293
7294
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007295log-tag <string>
7296 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7297 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7298 yes | yes | yes | yes
7299
7300 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7301 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7302 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7303 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7304 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7305 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7306 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7307 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7308 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007309
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007310max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7311 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7312 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7313 yes | no | yes | yes
7314
7315 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7316 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7317 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7318 servers.
7319
7320 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7321 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7322 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7323 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7324 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007325 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007326 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7327 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7328 picking a different server.
7329
7330 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7331 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7332 even if they have to be queued.
7333
7334 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7335 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7336
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007337max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7338 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7339 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7340 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007341
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007342maxconn <conns>
7343 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7345 yes | yes | yes | no
7346 Arguments :
7347 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7348 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7349 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7350 closes.
7351
7352 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7353 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7354 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7355 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007356 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7357 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7358 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7359 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007360
7361 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7362 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7363 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7364
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007365 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7366 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007367
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007368 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7369
7370
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007371mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007372 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7374 yes | yes | yes | yes
7375 Arguments :
7376 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7377 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7378 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7379 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7380
7381 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7382 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7383 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7384 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7385 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7386
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007387 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7388 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7389 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007390
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007391 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007392 defaults http_instances
7393 mode http
7394
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007395
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007396monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007397 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7399 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007400 Arguments :
7401 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7402 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007403 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007404 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7405 backend and its backup.
7406
7407 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7408 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7409 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7410 servers in a list of backends.
7411
7412 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7413 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7414 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7415 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7416 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7417 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7418 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007419 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7420 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007421
7422 Example:
7423 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007424 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007425 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7426 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7427 monitor-uri /site_alive
7428 monitor fail if site_dead
7429
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007430 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007431
7432
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007433monitor-uri <uri>
7434 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7436 yes | yes | yes | no
7437 Arguments :
7438 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7439 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7440
7441 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7442 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7443 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7444 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7445 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7446 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7447 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7448 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7449
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007450 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007451 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7452 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7453 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7454 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7455 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7456 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007457
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007458 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7459 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7460 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7461 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7462
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007463 Example :
7464 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7465 frontend www
7466 mode http
7467 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7468
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007469 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007470
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007471
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007472option abortonclose
7473no option abortonclose
7474 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7476 yes | no | yes | yes
7477 Arguments : none
7478
7479 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7480 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7481 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7482 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007483 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007484 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7485 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7486 encountered while delivering the response.
7487
7488 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7489 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7490 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7491 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7492 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7493 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007494 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007495 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007496 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007497 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7498 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7499 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7500
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007501 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7502 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007503 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7504 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7505 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7506 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7507 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7508 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007509 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007510
7511 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7512 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7513
7514 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7515
7516
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007517option accept-invalid-http-request
7518no option accept-invalid-http-request
7519 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7521 yes | yes | yes | no
7522 Arguments : none
7523
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007524 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007525 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007526 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007527 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7528 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7529 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7530 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7531 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007532 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7533 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7534 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7535 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007536 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007537 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007538 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7539 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7540 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007541
7542 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7543 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7544 been confirmed.
7545
7546 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7547 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007548 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7549 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007550 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7551
7552 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7553 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7554
7555 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7556 stats socket.
7557
7558
7559option accept-invalid-http-response
7560no option accept-invalid-http-response
7561 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7563 yes | no | yes | yes
7564 Arguments : none
7565
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007566 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007567 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007568 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007569 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7570 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7571 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7572 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7573 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007574 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7575 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7576 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007577
7578 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7579 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7580 been confirmed.
7581
7582 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7583 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7584 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7585 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7586
7587 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7588 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7589
7590 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7591 stats socket.
7592
7593
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007594option allbackups
7595no option allbackups
7596 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7598 yes | no | yes | yes
7599 Arguments : none
7600
7601 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7602 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7603 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7604 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7605 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7606 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7607 order between the backup servers anymore.
7608
7609 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7610 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7611
7612 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7613 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7614
7615
7616option checkcache
7617no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007618 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7620 yes | no | yes | yes
7621 Arguments : none
7622
7623 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7624 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007625 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007626 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7627 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007628 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007629
7630 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007631 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007632 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007633 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7634 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007635 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007636 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007637 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7638 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007639 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007640 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7641 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007642 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007643 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7644 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7645 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7646 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7647 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7648 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7649 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7650 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7651 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7652
7653 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007654 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7655 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7656 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7657 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007658
7659 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7660 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007661 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007662 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007663
7664 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7665 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7666
7667
7668option clitcpka
7669no option clitcpka
7670 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7672 yes | yes | yes | no
7673 Arguments : none
7674
7675 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7676 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007677 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007678 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7679
7680 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7681 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7682 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7683 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7684
7685 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7686 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7687 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7688 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7689 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7690
7691 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7692
7693 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7694 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7695 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7696
7697 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7698 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7699
7700 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7701
7702
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007703option contstats
7704 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7706 yes | yes | yes | no
7707 Arguments : none
7708
7709 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7710 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7711 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7712 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007713 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7714 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7715 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7716 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7717 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007718
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007719option disable-h2-upgrade
7720no option disable-h2-upgrade
7721 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7722 connection.
7723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7724 yes | yes | yes | no
7725 Arguments : none
7726
7727 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7728 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7729 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7730 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7731 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7732 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7733 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7734 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7735
7736 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7737 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007738
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007739option dontlog-normal
7740no option dontlog-normal
7741 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7743 yes | yes | yes | no
7744 Arguments : none
7745
7746 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7747 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7748 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7749 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7750 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7751 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7752 logged.
7753
7754 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7755 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7756 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7757
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007758 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007759 logging.
7760
7761
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007762option dontlognull
7763no option dontlognull
7764 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7766 yes | yes | yes | no
7767 Arguments : none
7768
7769 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7770 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7771 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7772 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7773 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7774 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007775 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7776 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7777 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007778
7779 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007780 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007781 would not be logged.
7782
7783 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7784 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7785
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007786 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007787 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007788
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007789
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007790option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007791 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7793 yes | yes | yes | yes
7794 Arguments :
7795 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7796 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007797 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007798 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007799
7800 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7801 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7802 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7803 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7804 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7805 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7806 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007807 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7808 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7809 possible that the client has already brought one.
7810
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007811 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007812 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007813 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007814 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007815 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007816 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007817
7818 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7819 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7820 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7821 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7822 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7823 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7824 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7825
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007826 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7827 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7828 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7829 are under the control of the end-user.
7830
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007831 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007832 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7833 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007834 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7835 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7836 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007837
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007838 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007839 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7840 frontend www
7841 mode http
7842 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7843
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007844 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7845 backend www
7846 mode http
7847 option forwardfor header X-Client
7848
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007849 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007850 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007851
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007852
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007853option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7854no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7855 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7857 yes | yes | yes | no
7858 Arguments : none
7859
7860 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7861 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7862 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7863 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7864 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7865 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7866 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7867
7868 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7869 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7870 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7871 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7872 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7873 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7874 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7875 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7876 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7877 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7878
7879 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7880
7881 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7882 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7883
7884 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7885 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7886
7887
7888option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7889no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7890 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7892 yes | no | yes | yes
7893 Arguments : none
7894
7895 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7896 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7897 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7898 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7899 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7900 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7901 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7902
7903 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7904 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7905 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7906 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7907 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7908 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7909 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7910 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7911 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7912 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7913
7914 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7915
7916 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7917 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7918
7919 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7920 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7921
7922
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007923option http-buffer-request
7924no option http-buffer-request
7925 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7927 yes | yes | yes | yes
7928 Arguments : none
7929
7930 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7931 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7932 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7933 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7934 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7935 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007936 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7937 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7938 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7939 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007940
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007941 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007942
7943
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007944option http-ignore-probes
7945no option http-ignore-probes
7946 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7948 yes | yes | yes | no
7949 Arguments : none
7950
7951 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7952 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7953 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7954 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7955 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7956 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7957 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7958 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7959 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007960 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7961 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007962 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7963
7964 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7965 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7966 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7967 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7968 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7969 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7970 are often the only way to detect them.
7971
7972 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7973 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7974
7975 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7976
7977
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007978option http-keep-alive
7979no option http-keep-alive
7980 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7982 yes | yes | yes | yes
7983 Arguments : none
7984
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007985 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7986 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007987 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7988 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007989 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7990 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7991 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007992
7993 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7994 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007995 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7996 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7997 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7998 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7999 situations where this option may be useful :
8000
8001 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008002 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008003
8004 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8005 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8006
8007 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8008 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8009 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8010 request.
8011
8012 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8013 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008014 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8015 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8016 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008017
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008018 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8019 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8020 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8021 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8022 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8023 not set.
8024
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008025 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8026 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8027 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008028
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008029 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008030 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008031 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008032
8033
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008034option http-no-delay
8035no option http-no-delay
8036 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8038 yes | yes | yes | yes
8039 Arguments : none
8040
8041 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8042 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8043 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8044 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8045 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8046 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8047 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8048 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8049 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8050 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8051 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8052 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8053 affected.
8054
8055 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8056 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8057 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8058 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8059 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8060 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8061 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8062 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8063 latency environments.
8064
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008065 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8066
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008067
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008068option http-pretend-keepalive
8069no option http-pretend-keepalive
8070 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008072 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008073 Arguments : none
8074
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008075 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008076 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8077 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8078 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8079 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8080 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8081 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8082 consider the response complete.
8083
8084 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8085 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8086 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8087 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008088 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008089 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8090
8091 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8092 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8093 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8094 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8095 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8096 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8097 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8098
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008099 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8100 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8101 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8102 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8103 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8104 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008105
8106 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8107 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8108
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008109 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008110 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008111
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008112
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008113option http-server-close
8114no option http-server-close
8115 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8117 yes | yes | yes | yes
8118 Arguments : none
8119
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008120 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8121 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8122 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8123 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008124 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8125 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8126 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8127 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8128 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8129 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8130 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8131 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8132 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8133 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8134 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008135
8136 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8137 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8138 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8139 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008140 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8141 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008142
8143 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8144 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008145 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8146 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8147 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008148
8149 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8150 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8151
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008152 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8153 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008154
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008155option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008156no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008157 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8159 yes | yes | yes | no
8160 Arguments : none
8161
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008162 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008163 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8164 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8165 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8166 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8167 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8168 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8169
8170 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8171 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008172 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8173 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8174 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008175
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008176 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8177 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8178 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8179 front of an existing proxy.
8180
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008181 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8182
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008183 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008184
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008185option httpchk
8186option httpchk <uri>
8187option httpchk <method> <uri>
8188option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008189 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8191 yes | no | yes | yes
8192 Arguments :
8193 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8194 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8195 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8196 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8197 ones.
8198
8199 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8200 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8201 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8202
8203 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8204 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8205 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008206 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008207
8208 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8209 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8210 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8211 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8212 the lack of any response.
8213
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008214 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8215 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8216 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8217 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8218
8219 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8220 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8221 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008222
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008223 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8224 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008225 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008226 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008227 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008228
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008229 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8230 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8231 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8232 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8233
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008234 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008235 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8236 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8237 backend https_relay
8238 mode tcp
8239 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8240 http-check send hdr Host www
8241 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008242
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008243 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8244 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8245 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008246
8247
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008248option httpclose
8249no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008250 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8252 yes | yes | yes | yes
8253 Arguments : none
8254
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008255 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8256 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8257 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8258 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008259 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008260
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008261 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8262 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008263 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008264 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8265 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008266
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008267 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8268 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8269 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008270
8271 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8272 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008273 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8274 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8275 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008276
8277 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8278 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8279
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008280 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008281
8282
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008283option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008284 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008286 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008287 Arguments :
8288 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8289 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8290 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008291 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008292 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008293
8294 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8295 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8296 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8297 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8298 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8299 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8300 ports.
8301
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008302 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8303 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008304
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008305 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8306
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008307 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008308
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008309
8310option http_proxy
8311no option http_proxy
8312 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8314 yes | yes | yes | yes
8315 Arguments : none
8316
8317 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8318 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8319 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8320 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8321 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8322
8323 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8324 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008325 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8326 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008327
8328 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8329 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8330
8331 Example :
8332 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8333 backend direct_forward
8334 option httpclose
8335 option http_proxy
8336
8337 See also : "option httpclose"
8338
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008339
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008340option independent-streams
8341no option independent-streams
8342 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8344 yes | yes | yes | yes
8345 Arguments : none
8346
8347 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8348 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8349 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8350 receive data or not.
8351
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008352 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008353 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8354 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8355 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8356 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8357 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8358 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8359 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8360 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8361 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8362 socket buffers.
8363
8364 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8365 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8366 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8367 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8368 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8369
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008370 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008371
8372
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008373option ldap-check
8374 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8376 yes | no | yes | yes
8377 Arguments : none
8378
8379 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8380 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8381 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8382 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8383
8384 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8385 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8386
8387 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8388 configure it.
8389
8390 Example :
8391 option ldap-check
8392
8393 See also : "option httpchk"
8394
8395
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008396option external-check
8397 Use external processes for server health checks
8398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8399 yes | no | yes | yes
8400
8401 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8402 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8403 command".
8404
8405 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8406
8407 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8408
8409
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008410option log-health-checks
8411no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008412 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8414 yes | no | yes | yes
8415 Arguments : none
8416
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008417 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8418 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8419 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008420
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008421 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8422 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8423 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8424 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8425 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8426
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008427 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008428 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008429
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008430 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8431 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8432 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008433
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008434
8435option log-separate-errors
8436no option log-separate-errors
8437 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8439 yes | yes | yes | no
8440 Arguments : none
8441
8442 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8443 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8444 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8445 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8446 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8447 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8448 provides very important information.
8449
8450 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8451 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8452 error logs.
8453
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008454 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008455 logging.
8456
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008457
8458option logasap
8459no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008460 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8462 yes | yes | yes | no
8463 Arguments : none
8464
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008465 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8466 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8467 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8468 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8469
8470 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8471 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8472 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8473 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8474 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008475 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008476 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8477 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8478 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8479 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008480 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008481
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008482 Examples :
8483 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8484 mode http
8485 option httplog
8486 option logasap
8487 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8488
8489 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8490 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8491 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8492 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8493
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008494 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008495 logging.
8496
8497
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008498option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008499 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8501 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008502 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008503 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8504 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008505 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8506 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008507
8508 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8509 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008510 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008511 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8512 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8513 in the MySQL table, like this :
8514
8515 USE mysql;
8516 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8517 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8518
8519 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008520 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008521 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8522 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8523 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8524 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8525 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8526 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8527 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8528
8529 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8530 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008531
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008532 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008533
8534 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8535 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8536 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8537 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008538 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8539 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008540
8541 See also: "option httpchk"
8542
8543
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008544option nolinger
8545no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008546 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008547 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8548 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008549 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008550
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008551 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008552 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8553 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8554 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8555 connections.
8556
8557 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8558 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008559 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8560 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8561 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8562 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8563 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8564 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8565 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8566 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8567 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8568 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8569 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8570 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8571 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008572
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008573 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8574 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8575 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8576 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8577 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008578
8579 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8580 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008581 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
8582 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidently
8583 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008584
8585 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8586 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8587
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008588 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
8589 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008590
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008591option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8592 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8594 yes | yes | yes | yes
8595 Arguments :
8596 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8597 matching <network>
8598 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8599 header name.
8600
8601 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8602 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8603 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8604 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8605 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8606 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8607 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8608 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8609 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8610 possible that the client has already brought one.
8611
8612 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8613 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8614 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8615 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8616 header and requires different one.
8617
8618 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8619 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8620 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8621 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8622 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8623 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8624 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8625
8626 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8627 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8628 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8629 both are defined.
8630
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008631 Examples :
8632 # Original Destination address
8633 frontend www
8634 mode http
8635 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8636
8637 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8638 backend www
8639 mode http
8640 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8641
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008642 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008643
8644
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008645option persist
8646no option persist
8647 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8648 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8649 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008650 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008651
8652 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8653 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8654 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8655 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8656 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8657 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8658 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8659 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8660 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8661 redirected to another valid server.
8662
8663 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8664 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8665
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008666 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008667
8668
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008669option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8670 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8672 yes | no | yes | yes
8673 Arguments :
8674 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8675 PostgreSQL server.
8676
8677 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8678 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8679 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8680 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8681
8682 See also: "option httpchk"
8683
8684
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008685option prefer-last-server
8686no option prefer-last-server
8687 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8688 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8689 yes | no | yes | yes
8690 Arguments : none
8691
8692 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8693 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8694 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8695 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8696 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8697 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8698 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8699 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8700 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008701 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8702 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008703 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8704 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8705 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008706 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8707 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8708 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008709
8710 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8711 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8712
8713 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8714
8715
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008716option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008717option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008718no option redispatch
8719 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8720 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8721 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008722 Arguments :
8723 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8724 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8725 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008726 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008727 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008728 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008729 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8730 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8731 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8732
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008733
8734 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8735 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8736 be able to access the service anymore.
8737
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008738 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8739 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008740
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008741 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8742 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8743 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8744 following order:
8745
8746 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8747
8748 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8749 list, or
8750
8751 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8752
8753 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8754 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8755
8756 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8757 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8758 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8759 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8760
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008761 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008762 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8763 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008764
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008765 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8766 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8767
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008768 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008769
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008770
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008771option redis-check
8772 Use redis health checks for server testing
8773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8774 yes | no | yes | yes
8775 Arguments : none
8776
8777 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8778 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8779 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8780 find the "+PONG" response message.
8781
8782 Example :
8783 option redis-check
8784
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008785 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008786
8787
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008788option smtpchk
8789option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8790 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8792 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008793 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008794 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008795 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008796 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8797
8798 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8799 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8800 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8801
8802 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8803 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8804 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8805 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8806 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8807 dead server.
8808
8809 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8810 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008811 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008812 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8813
8814 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8815 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8816 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8817 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008818 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008819
8820 Example :
8821 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8822
8823 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8824
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008825
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008826option socket-stats
8827no option socket-stats
8828
8829 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8831 yes | yes | yes | no
8832
8833 Arguments : none
8834
8835
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008836option splice-auto
8837no option splice-auto
8838 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8840 yes | yes | yes | yes
8841 Arguments : none
8842
8843 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8844 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008845 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008846 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008847 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008848 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8849 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8850 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8851 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8852
8853 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8854 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8855 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8856 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8857 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8858 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8859 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8860 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8861 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8862 keyword.
8863
8864 Example :
8865 option splice-auto
8866
8867 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8868 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8869
8870 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8871 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8872
8873
8874option splice-request
8875no option splice-request
8876 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8878 yes | yes | yes | yes
8879 Arguments : none
8880
8881 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008882 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008883 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8884 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8885 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8886 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8887
8888 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8889
8890 Example :
8891 option splice-request
8892
8893 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8894 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8895
8896 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8897 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8898
8899
8900option splice-response
8901no option splice-response
8902 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8904 yes | yes | yes | yes
8905 Arguments : none
8906
8907 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008908 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008909 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8910 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8911 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8912 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8913
8914 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8915
8916 Example :
8917 option splice-response
8918
8919 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8920 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8921
8922 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8923 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8924
8925
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008926option spop-check
8927 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8929 no | no | no | yes
8930 Arguments : none
8931
8932 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8933 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8934 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8935 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8936
8937 Example :
8938 option spop-check
8939
8940 See also : "option httpchk"
8941
8942
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008943option srvtcpka
8944no option srvtcpka
8945 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8947 yes | no | yes | yes
8948 Arguments : none
8949
8950 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8951 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008952 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008953 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8954
8955 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8956 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8957 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8958 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8959
8960 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8961 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8962 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8963 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8964 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8965
8966 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8967
8968 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8969 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8970 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8971
8972 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8973 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8974
8975 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8976
8977
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008978option ssl-hello-chk
8979 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8981 yes | no | yes | yes
8982 Arguments : none
8983
8984 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8985 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8986 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8987 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8988 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8989 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8990 hello message.
8991
8992 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8993 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8994 messages, which is appreciable.
8995
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008996 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8997 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8998 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008999
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009000 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9001
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009002
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009003option tcp-check
9004 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9005 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9006 yes | no | yes | yes
9007
9008 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9009 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9010
9011 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9012 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9013 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9014
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009015 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009016 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9017 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9018 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9019 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9020 only.
9021
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009022 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009023 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9024 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9025 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9026 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9027
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009028 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009029 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9030 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009031 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009032 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9033 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9034 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9035 the respective protocols.
9036 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009037 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009038
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009039 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009040
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009041 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9042 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9043 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9044 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009045
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009046 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9047 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9048 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009049
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009050
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009051 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009052 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009053 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009054 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009055
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009056 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009057 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009058 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009059
9060 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9061 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009062 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009063 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009064 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009065 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009066 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009067 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009068 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9069 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009070 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009071 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9072 tcp-check expect string +OK
9073
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009074 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009075 (send many headers before analyzing)
9076 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009077 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009078 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9079 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9080 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9081 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009082 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009083
9084
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009085 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009086
9087
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009088option tcp-smart-accept
9089no option tcp-smart-accept
9090 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9092 yes | yes | yes | no
9093 Arguments : none
9094
9095 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9096 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9097 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9098 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9099 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9100 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9101
9102 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9103 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9104 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9105 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9106
9107 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9108 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9109 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009110 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009111
9112 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9113 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9114 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9115
9116 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9117 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9118 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9119
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009120 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9121
9122
9123option tcp-smart-connect
9124no option tcp-smart-connect
9125 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9127 yes | no | yes | yes
9128 Arguments : none
9129
9130 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9131 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9132 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9133 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9134 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9135
9136 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9137 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9138 complex.
9139
9140 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9141 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9142 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9143
9144 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9145 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9146
9147 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9148
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009149
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009150option tcpka
9151 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9153 yes | yes | yes | yes
9154 Arguments : none
9155
9156 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9157 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009158 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009159 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9160
9161 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9162 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9163 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9164 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9165
9166 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9167 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9168 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9169 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9170 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9171
9172 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9173
9174 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9175 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9176 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9177 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9178 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9179 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9180 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9181 backends.
9182
9183 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9184
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009185
9186option tcplog
9187 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009189 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009190 Arguments : none
9191
9192 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9193 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9194 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9195 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9196 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9197 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9198 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9199 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9200
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009201 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9202
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009203 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009204
9205
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009206option transparent
9207no option transparent
9208 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009210 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009211 Arguments : none
9212
9213 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9214 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9215 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9216 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9217 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9218 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9219 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9220 appropriate server.
9221
9222 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9223 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9224
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009225 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009226 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009227
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009228
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009229external-check command <command>
9230 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9232 yes | no | yes | yes
9233
9234 Arguments :
9235 <command> is the external command to run
9236
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009237 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9238
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009239 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009240
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009241 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9242 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9243 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9244 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9245 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9246 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009247
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009248 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9249
9250 Environment variables :
9251 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9252 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9253
9254 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9255
9256 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9257
9258 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9259 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9260 for a UNIX socket).
9261
9262 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9263
9264 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9265
9266 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9267
9268 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9269
9270 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9271
9272 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9273 socket).
9274
9275 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9276 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9277
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009278 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9279
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009280 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9281 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9282 failed.
9283
9284 Example :
9285 external-check command /bin/true
9286
9287 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9288
9289
9290external-check path <path>
9291 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9293 yes | no | yes | yes
9294
9295 Arguments :
9296 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9297
9298 The default path is "".
9299
9300 Example :
9301 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9302
9303 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9304 "external-check command"
9305
9306
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009307persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009308persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009309 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9311 yes | no | yes | yes
9312 Arguments :
9313 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009314 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9315 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009316
9317 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9318 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009319 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009320 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9321 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9322 forwarded to this server.
9323
9324 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9325 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9326 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009327 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009328 a single "listen" section.
9329
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009330 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9331 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9332 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9333
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009334 Example :
9335 listen tse-farm
9336 bind :3389
9337 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9338 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9339 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9340 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9341 persist rdp-cookie
9342 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009343 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009344 balance rdp-cookie
9345 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9346 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9347
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009348 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9349 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009350
9351
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009352rate-limit sessions <rate>
9353 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9355 yes | yes | yes | no
9356 Arguments :
9357 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9358 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9359
9360 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9361 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9362 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9363 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9364 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9365 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9366
9367 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9368 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9369 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9370 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9371
9372 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9373 listen smtp
9374 mode tcp
9375 bind :25
9376 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009377 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009378
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009379 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9380 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9381 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009382
9383 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9384
9385
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009386redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9387redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9388redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009389 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9391 no | yes | yes | yes
9392
9393 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009394 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009395
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009396 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009397 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009398 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9399 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9400 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009401
9402 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9403 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9404 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9405 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9406 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009407 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9408 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9409 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9410 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009411
9412 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9413 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9414 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9415 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9416 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9417 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009418 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009419 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009420 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9421 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9422 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009423
9424 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009425 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9426 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9427 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009428 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009429 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9430 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9431 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9432 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009433
9434 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009435 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009436
9437 - "drop-query"
9438 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9439 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9440 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9441 with a location-type redirect.
9442
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009443 - "append-slash"
9444 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9445 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9446 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9447 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9448
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009449 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9450 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9451 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9452 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9453 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9454 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9455 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9456
9457 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9458 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9459 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9460 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9461 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9462 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9463 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009464
9465 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9466 acl clear dst_port 80
9467 acl secure dst_port 8080
9468 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009469 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009470 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009471 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9472
9473 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009474 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9475 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9476 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009477 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009478
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009479 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9480 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9481 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9482
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009483 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009484 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009485
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009486 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009487 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9488 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9489 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009490
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009491 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009492
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009493
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009494retries <value>
9495 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9496 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9497 yes | no | yes | yes
9498 Arguments :
9499 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9500 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9501 default value is 3.
9502
9503 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9504 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9505 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9506
9507 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009508 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9509 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009510
9511 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9512 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9513
9514 See also : "option redispatch"
9515
9516
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009517retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009518 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9519 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9520 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009521 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9522 yes | no | yes | yes
9523 Arguments :
9524 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9525 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9526 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9527 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9528
9529 none never retry
9530
9531 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9532 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9533
9534 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9535 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9536 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9537 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9538 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9539 processing the request.
9540
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009541 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9542 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9543 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9544 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9545 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9546 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9547 overflow attack for example).
9548
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009549 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9550 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9551 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9552 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9553 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9554 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9555 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9556 amplify denial of service attacks.
9557
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009558 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9559 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9560 considered to be safe to retry.
9561
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009562 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9563 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9564 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9565 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9566
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009567 all-retryable-errors
9568 retry request for any error that are considered
9569 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9570 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9571 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9572
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009573 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9574 not cumulative.
9575
9576 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9577 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9578 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9579 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9580
9581 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9582 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9583 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9584 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9585 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9586 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9587 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9588 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9589 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9590 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9591 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9592 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9593
9594 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9595 should not use this directive.
9596
9597 The default is "conn-failure".
9598
9599 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9600
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009601server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009602 Declare a server in a backend
9603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9604 no | no | yes | yes
9605 Arguments :
9606 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009607 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009608 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009609
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009610 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9611 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9612 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9613 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009614 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9615 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9616 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9617 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9618 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009619 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9620 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9621 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9622 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9623 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9624 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9625 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009626 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009627 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9628 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9629 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9630 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9631 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9632 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009633 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9634 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009635 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9636 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009637
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009638 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009639 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9640 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9641 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9642 adding this value to the client's port.
9643
9644 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9645 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009646 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009647
9648 Examples :
9649 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9650 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009651 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009652 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9653 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9654 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009655
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009656 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9657 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9658 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9659 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9660 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9661
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009662 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9663 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009664
Christopher Faulet05df94b2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009665server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009666 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet05df94b2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009667 this backend.
9668 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9669 no | no | yes | yes
9670
9671 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
9672 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
9673 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
9674 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
9675 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009676
9677 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9678 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9679
9680 global
9681 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9682
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009683 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009684 load-server-state-from-file
9685
Christopher Faulet05df94b2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009686 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009687 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009688
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009689server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9690 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9691 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9693 no | no | yes | yes
9694
9695 Arguments:
9696 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9697
9698 <num | range>
9699 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9700 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9701 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9702 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9703
9704 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9705
9706 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9707
9708 <params*>
9709 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9710 keyword.
9711
9712 Examples:
9713 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9714 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9715 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9716
9717 # or
9718 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9719
9720 # would be equivalent to:
9721 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9722 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9723 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9724
9725
9726
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009727source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009728source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009729source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009730 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9732 yes | no | yes | yes
9733 Arguments :
9734 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9735 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009736
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009737 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009738 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9739 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9740 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9741 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9742 supported prefixes are :
9743 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9744 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9745 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009746 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009747 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9748 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009749
9750 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9751 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009752 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9753 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9754 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009755
9756 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9757 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9758 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9759 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9760 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9761 <addr>.
9762
9763 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9764 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9765 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9766 port.
9767
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009768 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9769 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9770 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9771 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009772 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009773 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9774 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9775 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9776 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9777 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9778 HTTP header.
9779
9780 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9781 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009782 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009783 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9784 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9785 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9786 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9787 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9788 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9789 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9790
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009791 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9792 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9793 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9794 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9795 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9796 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9797
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009798 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9799 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9800 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9801 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9802
9803 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9804 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9805 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9806 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9807 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9808 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9809
9810 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9811 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9812 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9813 there are two methods :
9814
9815 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9816 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9817 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9818 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9819 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9820 of the client ranges may be used.
9821
9822 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9823 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9824 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9825 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9826 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9827 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9828 same session.
9829
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009830 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9831 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9832 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009833 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009834
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009835 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9836
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009837 Examples :
9838 backend private
9839 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9840 source 192.168.1.200
9841
9842 backend transparent_ssl1
9843 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9844 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9845
9846 backend transparent_ssl2
9847 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9848 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9849 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9850
9851 backend transparent_ssl3
9852 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9853 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9854 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9855
9856 backend transparent_smtp
9857 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9858 # with Tproxy version 4.
9859 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9860
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009861 backend transparent_http
9862 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9863 # proxy.
9864 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9865
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009866 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009867 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9868
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009869
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009870srvtcpka-cnt <count>
9871 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
9872 the connection on the server side.
9873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9874 yes | no | yes | yes
9875 Arguments :
9876 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
9877
9878 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
9879 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009880 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9881 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009882
9883 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9884
9885
9886srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
9887 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
9888 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
9889 server side.
9890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9891 yes | no | yes | yes
9892 Arguments :
9893 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
9894 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
9895 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
9896 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
9897
9898 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
9899 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009900 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9901 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009902
9903 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9904
9905
9906srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
9907 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
9908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9909 yes | no | yes | yes
9910 Arguments :
9911 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
9912 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
9913 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
9914 document.
9915
9916 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
9917 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009918 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9919 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009920
9921 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
9922
9923
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009924stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9925 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009927 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009928
9929 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9930 matched.
9931
9932 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9933 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9934
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009935 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9936 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009937 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009938
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009939 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9940 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9941 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9942 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009943
9944 Example :
9945 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9946 backend stats_localhost
9947 stats enable
9948 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9949
9950 Example :
9951 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9952 backend stats_auth
9953 stats enable
9954 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9955 stats admin if TRUE
9956
9957 Example :
9958 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9959 userlist stats-auth
9960 group admin users admin
9961 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9962 group readonly users haproxy
9963 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9964
9965 backend stats_auth
9966 stats enable
9967 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9968 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9969 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9970 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9971
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009972 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9973 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9974 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009975
9976
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009977stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9978 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009980 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009981 Arguments :
9982 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9983
9984 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9985
9986 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9987 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9988 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9989 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9990 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9991 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9992
9993 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9994 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9995 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009996 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009997
9998 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9999 report using "stats scope".
10000
10001 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10002 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10003 unobvious parameters.
10004
10005 Example :
10006 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10007 backend public_www
10008 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10009 stats enable
10010 stats hide-version
10011 stats scope .
10012 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010013 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010014 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10015 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10016
10017 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10018 backend private_monitoring
10019 stats enable
10020 stats uri /admin?stats
10021 stats refresh 5s
10022
10023 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10024
10025
10026stats enable
10027 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010029 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010030 Arguments : none
10031
10032 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10033 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10034 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10035 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10036 - stats auth : no authentication
10037 - stats scope : no restriction
10038
10039 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10040 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10041 unobvious parameters.
10042
10043 Example :
10044 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10045 backend public_www
10046 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10047 stats enable
10048 stats hide-version
10049 stats scope .
10050 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010051 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010052 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10053 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10054
10055 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10056 backend private_monitoring
10057 stats enable
10058 stats uri /admin?stats
10059 stats refresh 5s
10060
10061 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10062
10063
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010064stats hide-version
10065 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010067 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010068 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010069
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010070 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10071 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10072 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10073 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10074 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10075 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010076
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010077 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10078 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10079 unobvious parameters.
10080
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010081 Example :
10082 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10083 backend public_www
10084 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010085 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010086 stats hide-version
10087 stats scope .
10088 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010089 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010090 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10091 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010092
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010093 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10094 backend private_monitoring
10095 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010096 stats uri /admin?stats
10097 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010098
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010099 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010100
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010101
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010102stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10103 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10104 Access control for statistics
10105
10106 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10107 no | no | yes | yes
10108
10109 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10110 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10111 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10112 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10113 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10114 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10115
10116 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10117 instance.
10118
10119 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10120 about ACL usage.
10121
10122
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010123stats realm <realm>
10124 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010126 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010127 Arguments :
10128 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10129 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10130 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10131
10132 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10133 using a backslash ('\').
10134
10135 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10136 only related to authentication.
10137
10138 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10139 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10140 unobvious parameters.
10141
10142 Example :
10143 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10144 backend public_www
10145 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10146 stats enable
10147 stats hide-version
10148 stats scope .
10149 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010150 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010151 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10152 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10153
10154 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10155 backend private_monitoring
10156 stats enable
10157 stats uri /admin?stats
10158 stats refresh 5s
10159
10160 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10161
10162
10163stats refresh <delay>
10164 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010166 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010167 Arguments :
10168 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10169 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10170 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10171 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10172 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10173 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10174
10175 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10176 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10177 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010178 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010179
10180 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10181 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10182 unobvious parameters.
10183
10184 Example :
10185 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10186 backend public_www
10187 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10188 stats enable
10189 stats hide-version
10190 stats scope .
10191 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010192 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010193 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10194 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10195
10196 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10197 backend private_monitoring
10198 stats enable
10199 stats uri /admin?stats
10200 stats refresh 5s
10201
10202 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10203
10204
10205stats scope { <name> | "." }
10206 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010208 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010209 Arguments :
10210 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10211 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10212 section in which the statement appears.
10213
10214 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10215 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10216 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10217 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10218 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10219 exists.
10220
10221 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10222 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10223 unobvious parameters.
10224
10225 Example :
10226 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10227 backend public_www
10228 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10229 stats enable
10230 stats hide-version
10231 stats scope .
10232 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010233 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010234 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10235 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10236
10237 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10238 backend private_monitoring
10239 stats enable
10240 stats uri /admin?stats
10241 stats refresh 5s
10242
10243 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10244
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010245
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010246stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010247 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010249 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010250
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010251 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010252 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10253
10254 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10255 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10256
10257 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10258 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010259 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010260
10261 Example :
10262 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10263 backend private_monitoring
10264 stats enable
10265 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10266 stats uri /admin?stats
10267 stats refresh 5s
10268
10269 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10270 global section.
10271
10272
10273stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010274 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10276 yes | yes | yes | yes
10277 Arguments : none
10278
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010279 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010280 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10281 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10282 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10283 - IP (socket, server)
10284 - cookie (backend, server)
10285
10286 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10287 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010288 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010289
10290 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10291
10292
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010293stats show-modules
10294 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10296 yes | yes | yes | yes
10297 Arguments : none
10298
10299 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10300 values as a tooltip.
10301
10302 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10303 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10304 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10305
10306 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10307
10308
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010309stats show-node [ <name> ]
10310 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010312 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010313 Arguments:
10314 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10315 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10316
10317 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10318 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010319 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010320
10321 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10322 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10323 unobvious parameters.
10324
10325 Example:
10326 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10327 backend private_monitoring
10328 stats enable
10329 stats show-node Europe-1
10330 stats uri /admin?stats
10331 stats refresh 5s
10332
10333 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10334 section.
10335
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010336
10337stats uri <prefix>
10338 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010340 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010341 Arguments :
10342 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10343 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10344 query string.
10345
10346 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10347 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10348 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10349 possible to reach it in the application.
10350
10351 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010352 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010353 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10354 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10355 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10356 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10357
10358 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10359 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10360 an address or a port to statistics only.
10361
10362 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10363 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10364 unobvious parameters.
10365
10366 Example :
10367 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10368 backend public_www
10369 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10370 stats enable
10371 stats hide-version
10372 stats scope .
10373 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010374 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010375 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10376 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10377
10378 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10379 backend private_monitoring
10380 stats enable
10381 stats uri /admin?stats
10382 stats refresh 5s
10383
10384 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10385
10386
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010387stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10388 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010390 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010391
10392 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010393 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010394 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010395 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010396 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10397
10398 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10399 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10400 the "stick-table" statement.
10401
10402 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10403 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10404 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10405 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10406 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10407
10408 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10409 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10410 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10411 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10412 transformation rules.
10413
10414 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10415 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10416 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10417 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10418 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10419 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10420 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10421
10422 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10423 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10424 ACL based conditions.
10425
10426 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10427 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10428 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10429 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10430
10431 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10432 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10433 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10434 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10435
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010436 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10437 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010438 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010439
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010440 Example :
10441 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10442 # last 30 minutes
10443 backend pop
10444 mode tcp
10445 balance roundrobin
10446 stick store-request src
10447 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10448 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10449 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10450
10451 backend smtp
10452 mode tcp
10453 balance roundrobin
10454 stick match src table pop
10455 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10456 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10457
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010458 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010459 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010460
10461
10462stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10463 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10465 no | no | yes | yes
10466
10467 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10468 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10469 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10470 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10471
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010472 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10473 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010474 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010475
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010476 Examples :
10477 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010478 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010479
10480 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10481 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10482 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10483
10484
10485 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10486 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10487 backend http
10488 mode http
10489 balance roundrobin
10490 stick on src table https
10491 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10492 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10493 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10494
10495 backend https
10496 mode tcp
10497 balance roundrobin
10498 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10499 stick on src
10500 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10501 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10502
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010503 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010504
10505
10506stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10507 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10509 no | no | yes | yes
10510
10511 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010512 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010513 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010514 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010515 server is selected.
10516
10517 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10518 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10519 the "stick-table" statement.
10520
10521 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10522 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10523 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10524 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10525 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10526 address.
10527
10528 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10529 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10530 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10531 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10532 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10533 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10534 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10535 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10536 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10537 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10538
10539 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10540 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10541 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10542 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10543 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10544 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10545 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10546
10547 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10548 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10549 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10550 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10551
10552 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10553 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10554 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10555 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10556 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10557 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010558 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10559 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10560 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10561 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10562 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10563 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010564
10565 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10566 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10567 the request.
10568
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010569 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10570 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010571 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010572
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010573 Example :
10574 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10575 # last 30 minutes
10576 backend pop
10577 mode tcp
10578 balance roundrobin
10579 stick store-request src
10580 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10581 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10582 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10583
10584 backend smtp
10585 mode tcp
10586 balance roundrobin
10587 stick match src table pop
10588 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10589 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10590
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010591 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010592 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010593
10594
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010595stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010596 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10597 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010598 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010600 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010601
10602 Arguments :
10603 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10604 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10605 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10606 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10607
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010608 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10609 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10610 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10611 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10612
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010613 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10614 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10615 instance.
10616
10617 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10618 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10619 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10620 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10621 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10622 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010623 to 32 characters.
10624
10625 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10626 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10627 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010628 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010629 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10630 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010631
10632 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010633 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10634 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010635 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10636 increase.
10637
10638 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010639 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10640 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10641 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010642
10643 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10644 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10645 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10646 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010647 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010648 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10649 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10650 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10651 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10652 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10653 parameter (see below).
10654
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010655 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10656 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10657 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10658 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10659 soft restart.
10660
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010661 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10662 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010663
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010664 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10665 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10666 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10667 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010668 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010669 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010670 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10671 if not expiration delay is specified.
10672
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010673 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10674 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10675 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10676 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010677 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10678 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10679 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10680 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10681 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10682 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10683 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10684 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10685 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10686 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10687 types and their arguments.
10688
10689 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10690 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10691 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10692 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10693
10694 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10695 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10696 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010697 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010698
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010699 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10700 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10701 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010702 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010703 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010704 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010705
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010706 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10707 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10708 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10709 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10710
10711 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10712 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10713 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10714 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10715 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10716 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10717
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010718 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10719 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10720 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10721 they were received.
10722
10723 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10724 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10725 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10726 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10727 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10728
10729 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10730 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10731 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10732 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10733 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10734
10735 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10736 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10737 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10738
10739 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10740 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10741 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10742 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10743 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10744
10745 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10746 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10747 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10748 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10749 the client side.
10750
10751 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10752 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10753 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10754 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10755 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10756 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10757 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10758
10759 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10760 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10761 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10762 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10763 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10764 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010765 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010766
10767 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10768 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10769 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10770 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10771 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10772 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10773
10774 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010775 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010776 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10777 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10778
10779 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10780 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10781 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10782 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10783 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10784 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10785 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10786 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10787 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10788 recommended for better fairness.
10789
10790 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010791 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010792 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10793 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10794
10795 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10796 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10797 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10798 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10799 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10800 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10801 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10802 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10803 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10804 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010805
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010806 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10807 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010808 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10809 reference it.
10810
10811 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10812 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010813 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10814 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10815 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010816
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010817 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10818 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10819 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10820 something that can be ignored.
10821
10822 Example:
10823 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10824 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10825 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10826 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10827
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010828 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010829 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010830
10831
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010832stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010833 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10835 no | no | yes | yes
10836
10837 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010838 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010839 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010840 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010841 server is selected.
10842
10843 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10844 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10845 the "stick-table" statement.
10846
10847 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10848 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10849 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10850 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10851
10852 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10853 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10854 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10855 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10856 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10857 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010858 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010859 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10860 rules.
10861
10862 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10863 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10864 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10865 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10866 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10867 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10868 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10869
10870 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10871 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10872 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10873 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10874
10875 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10876 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10877 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10878 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10879 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10880 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010881 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10882 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10883 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10884 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10885 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10886 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10887 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10888 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10889 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010890
10891 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10892
10893 Example :
10894 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10895 backend https
10896 mode tcp
10897 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010898 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010899 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010900
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010901 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10902 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10903
10904 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10905 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10906 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10907
10908 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10909 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010910
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010911 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10912 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10913 # at offset 44.
10914
10915 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10916 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10917
10918 # Learn on response if server hello.
10919 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010920
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010921 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10922 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10923
10924 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10925 extraction.
10926
10927
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010928tcp-check comment <string>
10929 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10930 it fails.
10931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10932 yes | no | yes | yes
10933
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010934 Arguments :
10935 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10936 rule fails.
10937
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010938 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10939 user-friendly error reporting.
10940
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010941 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10942 "tcp-check expect".
10943
10944
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010945tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10946 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010947 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010948 Opens a new connection
10949 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010950 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010951
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010952 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010953 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10954
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010955 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010956 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010957
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010958 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010959 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10960 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010961 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010962
10963 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010964
10965 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10966
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010967 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10968
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010969 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10970
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010971 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10972
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010973 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10974 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10975 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10976 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10977
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010978 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10979 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10980 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10981 haproxy -vv.
10982
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010983 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010984
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010985 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10986 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10987 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10988
10989 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10990 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10991 of the sequence.
10992
10993 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10994 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10995 do.
10996
10997 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10998 unset-var or comment rules.
10999
11000 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011001 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11002 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11003 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11004 option tcp-check
11005 tcp-check connect
11006 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11007 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11008 tcp-check send \r\n
11009 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11010 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11011 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11012 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11013 tcp-check send \r\n
11014 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11015 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11016
11017 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11018 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011019 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011020 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11021 tcp-check connect port 143
11022 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11023 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11024
11025 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11026
11027
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011028tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011029 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011030 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011031 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011032 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011033 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011034 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011035
11036 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011037 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11038
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011039 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11040 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11041 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11042 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11043 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11044 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11045 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11046 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11047 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11048 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11049
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011050 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011051 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11052 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011053 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11054 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11055 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11056
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011057 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11058 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11059 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011060 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11061 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
11062 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
11063 example 404 with disable-on-404
11064 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11065 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011066 By default "L7OK" is used.
11067
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011068 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11069 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011070 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
11071 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11072 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11073 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11074 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11075 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011076
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011077 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011078 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011079 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11080 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11081 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11082 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011083 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11084
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011085 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11086 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11087 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11088 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11089
11090 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11091 informational message reported in logs if an error
11092 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11093 log-format string.
11094
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011095 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11096 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11097 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11098 followed by some converters.
11099
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011100 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11101 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11102 with the usual backslash ('\').
11103 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011104 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011105 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11106 used upper or lower case.
11107
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011108 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11109
11110 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11111 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11112 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11113 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11114 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11115 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11116 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11117 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11118
11119 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11120 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11121 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11122 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11123 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11124 expression.
11125
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011126 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11127 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11128 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11129 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11130 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11131 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11132
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011133 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11134 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11135 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11136 this exact hexadecimal string.
11137 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11138
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011139 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11140 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11141 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11142 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11143 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11144 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11145 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11146 size.
11147
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011148 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11149 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11150 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11151 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11152 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11153 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11154 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11155 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11156 in a binary string before matching the response's
11157 buffer.
11158
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011159 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Faulet7151a122020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011160 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011161 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11162 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11163 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11164 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11165 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11166 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11167 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11168 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11169 the null character.
11170
11171 Examples :
11172 # perform a POP check
11173 option tcp-check
11174 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11175
11176 # perform an IMAP check
11177 option tcp-check
11178 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11179
11180 # look for the redis master server
11181 option tcp-check
11182 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011183 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011184 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11185 tcp-check expect string role:master
11186 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11187 tcp-check expect string +OK
11188
11189
11190 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Faulet7151a122020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011191 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011192
11193
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011194tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11195tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11196 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11197 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011198 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011199 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011200
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011201 Arguments :
11202 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11203
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011204 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11205 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011206
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011207 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11208 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011209
11210 Examples :
11211 # look for the redis master server
11212 option tcp-check
11213 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11214 tcp-check expect string role:master
11215
11216 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Faulet7151a122020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011217 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011218
11219
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011220tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11221tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11222 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11223 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011224 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011225 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011226
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011227 Arguments :
11228 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011229
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011230 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11231 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011232
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011233 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11234 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11235 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011236
11237 Examples :
11238 # redis check in binary
11239 option tcp-check
11240 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11241 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11242
11243
11244 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Faulet7151a122020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011245 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011246
11247
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011248tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011249 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011250 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011251 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011252
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011253 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011254 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11255 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11256 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11257 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11258 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11259 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11260 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11261 and '-'.
11262
11263 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11264
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011265 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011266 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11267
11268
11269tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011270 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011271 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011272 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011273
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011274 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011275 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11276 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11277 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11278 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11279 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11280 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11281 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11282 and '-'.
11283
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011284 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011285 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11286
11287
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011288tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11289 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11291 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011292 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011293 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11294 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011295
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011296 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011297
11298 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11299 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011300 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11301 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11302 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11303 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11304 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11305 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011306
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011307 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11308 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11309 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11310 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011311
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011312 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011313 - accept :
11314 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11315 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11316 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011317
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011318 - reject :
11319 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11320 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11321 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11322 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11323 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11324 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11325 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11326 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11327 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11328 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11329 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011330 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011331
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011332 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11333 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11334 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11335 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11336 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11337 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11338 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11339 hosts.
11340
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011341 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11342 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11343 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11344 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11345 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11346 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11347 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11348 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11349
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011350 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11351 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11352 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11353 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11354 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11355 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11356 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11357 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11358 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011359 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11360 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011361
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011362 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011363 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011364 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11365 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11366 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011367 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011368 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011369 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11370 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11371 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11372 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11373 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11374 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11375 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011376
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011377 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011378 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011379 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011380 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011381 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11382 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11383 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011384
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011385 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11386 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11387 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11388 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011389
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011390 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11391 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11392 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11393 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11394 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011395 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11396 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11397 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11398 layer7 information is extracted.
11399
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011400 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11401 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11402 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11403 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11404 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011405
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011406 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11407 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11408 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11409 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11410
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011411 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11412 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11413 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11414 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11415
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011416 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11417 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11418 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11419 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11420 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011421
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011422 - set-src <expr> :
11423 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11424 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11425 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011426 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011427
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011428 Arguments:
11429 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11430 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011431
11432 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011433 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11434
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011435 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11436 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011437
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011438 - set-src-port <expr> :
11439 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11440 expression.
11441
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011442 Arguments:
11443 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11444 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011445
11446 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011447 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11448
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011449 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11450 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11451 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011452
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011453 - set-dst <expr> :
11454 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11455 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11456 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11457 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11458 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11459
11460 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11461 followed by some converters.
11462
11463 Example:
11464
11465 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11466 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11467
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011468 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11469 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11470
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011471 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11472 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11473 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11474 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11475
11476
11477 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11478 followed by some converters.
11479
11480 Example:
11481
11482 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11483
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011484 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11485 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11486 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11487
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011488 - "silent-drop" :
11489 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011490 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011491 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11492 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11493 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11494 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11495 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011496 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11497 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011498 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11499 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011500 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011501 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11502 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11503 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11504 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11505
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011506 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11507 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11508 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011509
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011510 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11511 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11512 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011513
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011514 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011515 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011516 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011517
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011518 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11519 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11520 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011521
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011522 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011523 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11524 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011525
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011526 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11527
11528 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11529
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011530 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11531
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011532 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011533
11534
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011535tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11536 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011538 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011539 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011540 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11541 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011542
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011543 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011544
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011545 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011546 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11547 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11548 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11549 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011550
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011551 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11552 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11553 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11554 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011555 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11556 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11557 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11558 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11559 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11560 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011561 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011562 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011563
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011564 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11565 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11566 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11567 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011568
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011569 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011570 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011571 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011572 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11573 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011574 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011575 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011576 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011577 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011578 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011579 - set-dst <expr>
11580 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011581 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011582 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011583 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011584 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011585 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011586
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011587 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11588 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011589 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11590 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011591
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011592 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11593 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11594 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11595 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11596 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11597 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011598
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011599 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011600 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11601 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011602
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011603 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11604 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11605 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11606 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11607 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11608 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11609
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011610 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011611 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11612 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11613 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11614 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11615 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11616 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11617 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11618 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11619 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11620 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011621
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011622 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011623 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11624 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11625 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011626
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011627 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11628 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11629
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011630 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011631 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11632 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011633
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011634 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11635 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011636 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011637 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11638 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011639 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011640 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011641 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011642 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11643 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011644 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011645 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11646 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011647
11648 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11649 followed by some converters.
11650
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011651 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11652 <var-name>.
11653
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011654 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11655 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11656 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11657 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11658 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11659
11660 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11661 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11662 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11663 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11664 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11665 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11666 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11667 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11668 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11669 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11670 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11671
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011672 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11673 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11674 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11675 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11676 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11677
11678 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11679
11680 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11681
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011682 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11683 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11684 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11685 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11686 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11687 evaluated.
11688
11689 Example:
11690 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11691
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011692 Example:
11693
11694 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011695 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011696
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011697 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011698 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11699 # and reject everything else.
11700 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11701 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011702 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011703 tcp-request content reject
11704
11705 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011706 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11707 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11708 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011709 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011710
11711 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11712 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11713 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011714 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011715 tcp-request content reject
11716
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011717 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011718 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011719 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011720 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011721 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11722 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011723
11724 Example:
11725 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11726 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011727 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011728
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011729 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011730 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011731
11732 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011733 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011734 # protecting all our sites
11735 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011736 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11737 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011738 ...
11739 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11740
11741 backend http_dynamic
11742 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011743 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011744 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011745 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011746 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011747 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011748 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011749
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011750 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011751
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011752 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11753 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011754
11755
11756tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11757 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011759 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011760 Arguments :
11761 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11762 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11763 as explained at the top of this document.
11764
11765 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11766 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11767 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11768 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11769 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11770
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011771 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11772 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11773 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11774 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11775
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011776 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11777 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011778 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011779 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011780 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11781 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11782 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11783 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011784
11785 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11786 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11787 it pass through unaffected.
11788
11789 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11790 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11791 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011792 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011793 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11794 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011795 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11796 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11797 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011798
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011799 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011800 "timeout client".
11801
11802
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011803tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11804 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11806 no | no | yes | yes
11807 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011808 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11809 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011810
11811 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11812
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011813 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011814 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11815 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011816 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11817 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011818
11819 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11820
11821 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11822 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11823 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11824 inserted.
11825
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011826 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011827 - accept :
11828 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11829 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11830 the rules evaluation.
11831
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011832 - close :
11833 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11834 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11835 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11836 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11837 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11838 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011839 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011840 protocols.
11841
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011842 - reject :
11843 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11844 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011845 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011846
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011847 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11848 Sets a variable.
11849
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011850 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11851 Unsets a variable.
11852
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011853 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11854 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11855 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11856 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11857
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011858 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11859 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11860 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11861 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11862
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011863 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11864 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11865 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11866 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11867 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011868
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011869 - "silent-drop" :
11870 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011871 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011872 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11873 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11874 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11875 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11876 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011877 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11878 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011879 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11880 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011881 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011882 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11883 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11884 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11885 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11886
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011887 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11888 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11889
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011890 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11891 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11892 for changing the default action to a reject.
11893
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011894 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11895 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11896 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11897 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011898 period.
11899
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011900 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11901 declared inline.
11902
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011903 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11904 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011905 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011906 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11907 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011908 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011909 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011910 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011911 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11912 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011913 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011914 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11915 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011916
11917 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11918 followed by some converters.
11919
11920 Example:
11921
11922 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11923
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011924 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11925 <var-name>.
11926
11927 Example:
11928
11929 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11930
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011931 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11932 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11933 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11934 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11935 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11936
11937 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11938
11939 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11940
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011941 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11942
11943 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11944
11945
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011946tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11947 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11949 no | yes | yes | no
11950 Arguments :
11951 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11952 below.
11953
11954 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11955
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011956 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011957 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11958 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11959 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11960 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11961 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11962 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11963 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011964 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011965 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11966 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11967 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11968 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11969 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11970 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11971 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11972 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11973 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11974 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11975 instead.
11976
11977 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11978 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11979 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11980 rules which may be inserted.
11981
11982 Several types of actions are supported :
11983 - accept : the request is accepted
11984 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11985 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11986 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011987 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011988 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011989 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011990 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011991 - silent-drop
11992
11993 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11994 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11995 sections for a complete description.
11996
11997 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11998 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11999 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12000
12001 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12002 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12003 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12004 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12005 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12006
12007 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12008 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12009
12010 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12011 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12012 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12013
12014 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12015 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12016 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12017
12018 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12019 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12020 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12021
12022 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12023 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12024 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12025
12026 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12027
12028 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12029
12030
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012031tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12032 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12034 no | no | yes | yes
12035 Arguments :
12036 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12037 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12038 as explained at the top of this document.
12039
12040 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12041
12042
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012043timeout check <timeout>
12044 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12045 established.
12046
12047 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12048 yes | no | yes | yes
12049 Arguments:
12050 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12051 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12052 as explained at the top of this document.
12053
12054 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12055 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012056 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012057 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012058 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12059 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12060 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012061
12062 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12063 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12064
12065 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12066 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012067 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012068
12069 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12070 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12071 forget about it.
12072
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012073 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12074 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012075
12076
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012077timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012078 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12080 yes | yes | yes | no
12081 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012082 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012083 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12084 as explained at the top of this document.
12085
12086 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12087 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12088 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012089 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12090 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12091 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12092 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012093 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12094 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12095 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012096 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012097 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012098 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12099 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012100 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12101 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012102
12103 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12104 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12105 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12106 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012107 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012108 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12109
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012110 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012111
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012112 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012113
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012114
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012115timeout client-fin <timeout>
12116 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12118 yes | yes | yes | no
12119 Arguments :
12120 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12121 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12122 as explained at the top of this document.
12123
12124 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12125 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12126 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12127 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12128 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12129 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12130 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012131 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12132 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12133 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012134
12135 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12136 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12137 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12138
12139 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12140
12141
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012142timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012143 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12145 yes | no | yes | yes
12146 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012147 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012148 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12149 as explained at the top of this document.
12150
12151 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012152 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012153 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012154 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012155 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12156 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012157
12158 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12159 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12160 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12161 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012162 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012163 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12164
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012165 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012166
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012167
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012168timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12169 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12171 yes | yes | yes | yes
12172 Arguments :
12173 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12174 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12175 as explained at the top of this document.
12176
12177 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12178 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12179 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12180 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12181 once the request has started to present itself.
12182
12183 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12184 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12185 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12186 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12187 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12188
12189 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12190 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12191 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12192 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12193
12194 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12195 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012196 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012197 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12198 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012199 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012200
12201 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12202 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12203 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12204 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12205
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012206 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12207 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012208 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12209
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012210 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12211
12212
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012213timeout http-request <timeout>
12214 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012216 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012217 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012218 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012219 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12220 as explained at the top of this document.
12221
12222 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12223 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12224 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12225 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12226 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12227 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12228 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012229 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12230 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12231 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12232 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012233 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012234 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12235 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012236
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012237 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12238 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12239 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12240 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12241 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012242 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012243
12244 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12245 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012246 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012247 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12248 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12249
12250 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012251 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12252 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12253 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012254
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012255 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012256 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012257
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012258
12259timeout queue <timeout>
12260 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12262 yes | no | yes | yes
12263 Arguments :
12264 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12265 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12266 as explained at the top of this document.
12267
12268 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12269 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12270 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12271 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12272 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12273
12274 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12275 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12276 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12277 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12278
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012279 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012280
12281
12282timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012283 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12285 yes | no | yes | yes
12286 Arguments :
12287 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12288 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12289 as explained at the top of this document.
12290
12291 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12292 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12293 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12294 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12295 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12296 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12297 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12298
12299 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12300 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12301 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12302 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12303 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012304 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012305 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012306 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12307 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012308 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12309 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012310
12311 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12312 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12313 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12314 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012315 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012316 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12317
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012318 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012319
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012320
12321timeout server-fin <timeout>
12322 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12324 yes | no | yes | yes
12325 Arguments :
12326 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12327 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12328 as explained at the top of this document.
12329
12330 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12331 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12332 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12333 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12334 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12335 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12336 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12337 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12338 situations, it should not be needed.
12339
12340 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12341 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12342 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12343
12344 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12345
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012346
12347timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012348 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12350 yes | yes | yes | yes
12351 Arguments :
12352 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12353 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12354 as explained at the top of this document.
12355
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012356 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12357 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12358 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012359
12360 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12361 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12362 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12363 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012364 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012365
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012366 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012367
12368
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012369timeout tunnel <timeout>
12370 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12372 yes | no | yes | yes
12373 Arguments :
12374 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12375 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12376 as explained at the top of this document.
12377
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012378 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012379 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12380 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12381 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012382 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12383 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012384 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12385 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12386 specified.
12387
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012388 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12389 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12390 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12391 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12392 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12393 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12394 state.
12395
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012396 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12397 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12398 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12399 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012400 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012401
12402 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12403 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12404 forget about it.
12405
12406 Example :
12407 defaults http
12408 option http-server-close
12409 timeout connect 5s
12410 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012411 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012412 timeout server 30s
12413 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12414
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012415 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012416
12417
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012418transparent (deprecated)
12419 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012421 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012422 Arguments : none
12423
12424 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12425 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12426 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12427 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12428 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12429 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12430 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12431 appropriate server.
12432
12433 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12434
12435 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12436 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12437
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012438 See also: "option transparent"
12439
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012440unique-id-format <string>
12441 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12443 yes | yes | yes | no
12444 Arguments :
12445 <string> is a log-format string.
12446
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012447 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12448 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12449 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12450 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012451
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012452 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12453 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12454 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12455 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12456 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12457 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12458 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12459 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012460
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012461 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12462 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012463
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012464 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012465
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012466 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012467
12468 will generate:
12469
12470 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12471
12472 See also: "unique-id-header"
12473
12474unique-id-header <name>
12475 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12477 yes | yes | yes | no
12478 Arguments :
12479 <name> is the name of the header.
12480
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012481 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12482 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012483
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012484 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012485
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012486 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012487 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12488
12489 will generate:
12490
12491 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12492
12493 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012494
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012495use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012496 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12498 no | yes | yes | no
12499 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012500 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12501 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012502
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012503 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12504 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012505
12506 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12507 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12508 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012509 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012510 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012511 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12512 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012513
12514 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12515 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12516 assign the backend.
12517
12518 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12519 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12520 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12521 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12522 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12523 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12524
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012525 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012526 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012527 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12528 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12529 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12530
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012531 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12532 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12533 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12534 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12535 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12536 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12537 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12538 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12539 cannot be forced from the request.
12540
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012541 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012542 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12543 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12544
12545 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12546 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012547
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012548use-fcgi-app <name>
12549 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12551 no | no | yes | yes
12552 Arguments :
12553 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12554
12555 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012556
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012557use-server <server> if <condition>
12558use-server <server> unless <condition>
12559 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12561 no | no | yes | yes
12562 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012563 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12564 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012565
12566 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12567
12568 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12569 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12570 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12571
12572 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12573 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12574 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12575 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12576 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12577 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12578 matches will assign the server.
12579
12580 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12581 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12582 with the next rules until one matches.
12583
12584 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12585 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12586 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12587 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12588
12589 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12590 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12591 stripped.
12592
12593 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12594 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012595 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12596 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12597 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012598
12599 Example :
12600 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12601 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12602 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12603 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012604 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012605 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012606 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012607 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12608 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12609
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012610 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12611 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12612 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12613 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012614 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012615 and we fall back to load balancing.
12616
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012617 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012618
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012619
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100126205. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012621--------------------------
12622
12623The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12624depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12625settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12626written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12627described in this section.
12628
12629
126305.1. Bind options
12631-----------------
12632
12633The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12634as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12635no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12636parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12637while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12638provided immediately after the setting name.
12639
12640The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12641
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012642accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12643 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12644 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12645 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12646 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12647 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12648 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12649 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12650 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12651 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012652 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12653 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12654 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012655
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012656accept-proxy
12657 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012658 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12659 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012660 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12661 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12662 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12663 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012664 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012665 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12666 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012667 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12668 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012669
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012670allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012671 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012672 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012673 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012674 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12675 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012676
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012677alpn <protocols>
12678 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12679 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12680 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012681 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012682 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012683 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12684 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12685 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12686 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12687 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12688 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12689 preference, like below :
12690
12691 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012692
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012693backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012694 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012695 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12696
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012697curves <curves>
12698 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12699 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12700 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12701 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12702 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12703 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12704
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012705ecdhe <named curve>
12706 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012707 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12708 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012709
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012710ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012711 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12712 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12713 client's certificate.
12714
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012715ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12716 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12717 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12718 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12719 error is ignored.
12720
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012721ca-sign-file <cafile>
12722 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12723 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12724 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12725 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12726 'generate-certificates' for details.
12727
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012728ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012729 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12730 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12731 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12732 'generate-certificates' for details.
12733
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012734ca-verify-file <cafile>
12735 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12736 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12737 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12738 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12739 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12740
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012741ciphers <ciphers>
12742 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12743 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012744 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012745 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012746 information and recommendations see e.g.
12747 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12748 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12749 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12750
12751ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12752 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12753 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12754 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12755 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012756 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12757 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012758
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012759crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012760 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12761 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12762 to verify client's certificate.
12763
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012764crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012765 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12766 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12767 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12768 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12769 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012770 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12771 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012772
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012773 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12774 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12775
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012776 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12777 are loaded.
12778
12779 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012780 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12781 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12782 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12783 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12784 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12785 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12786 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012787 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012788
12789 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12790 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12791 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12792 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012793 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12794 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012795
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012796 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012797
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012798 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012799 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012800 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12801 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012802 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12803 clients).
12804
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012805 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12806 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12807 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12808 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12809 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12810 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12811 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12812 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12813 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12814 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12815 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12816 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12817 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12818
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012819 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12820 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12821 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12822 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12823 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12824
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012825 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12826 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12827 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12828 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012829
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012830 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
12831 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
12832 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012833
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012834crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012835 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012836 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012837 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012838 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012839
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012840crt-list <file>
12841 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012842 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12843 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012844
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012845 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12846
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012847 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12848 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12849 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12850 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12851 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012852
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012853 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraiscaaa46c2020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012854 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
12855 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
12856 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
12857 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
12858 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012859 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12860 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12861 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012862
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012863 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
12864 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
12865 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012866
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012867 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12868
Joao Morais5ae6bfc2020-11-24 08:24:30 -030012869 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
12870 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
12871 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
12872 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
12873 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
12874 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
12875 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
12876 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraiscaaa46c2020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012877
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012878 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraiscaaa46c2020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012879 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012880 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012881 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012882 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012883 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012884
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012885defer-accept
12886 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12887 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12888 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012889 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012890 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12891 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12892 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12893 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12894 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12895 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12896 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12897
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012898expose-fd listeners
12899 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12900 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012901 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12902 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012903 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012904
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012905force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012906 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012907 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012908 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012909 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012910
12911force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012912 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012913 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012914 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012915
12916force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012917 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012918 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012919 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012920
12921force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012922 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012923 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012924 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012925
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012926force-tlsv13
12927 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12928 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012929 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012930
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012931generate-certificates
12932 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12933 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12934 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12935 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12936 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12937 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12938 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12939 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12940 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12941 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12942 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12943
12944 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12945 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012946 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012947 certificate is used many times.
12948
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012949gid <gid>
12950 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12951 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12952 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12953 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12954 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12955
12956group <group>
12957 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12958 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12959 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12960 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12961 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12962
12963id <id>
12964 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12965 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12966 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12967 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12968
12969interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012970 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12971 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12972 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12973 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12974 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12975 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012976 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12977 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12978 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12979 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12980 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12981 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012982
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012983level <level>
12984 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12985 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12986 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012987 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012988 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12989 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12990 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012991 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012992 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012993 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012994 all counters).
12995
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012996severity-output <format>
12997 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12998 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12999 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13000 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13001 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13002 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13003 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13004 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13005 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13006 rfc5424 convention.
13007
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013008maxconn <maxconn>
13009 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13010 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13011 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13012 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13013 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13014 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13015 eat all memory.
13016
13017mode <mode>
13018 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13019 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13020 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13021 UNIX sockets.
13022
13023mss <maxseg>
13024 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13025 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13026 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13027 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13028 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13029 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13030 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13031 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13032 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13033 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13034 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13035
13036name <name>
13037 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13038 page.
13039
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013040namespace <name>
13041 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13042 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13043 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13044 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13045
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013046nice <nice>
13047 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13048 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13049 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13050 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13051 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13052 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13053 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13054 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13055 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13056 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13057 one for an RDP socket.
13058
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013059no-ca-names
13060 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13061 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013062 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013063
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013064no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013065 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013066 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013067 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013068 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013069 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13070 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013071
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013072no-tls-tickets
13073 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13074 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13075 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013076 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13077 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013078 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13079 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13080 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013081
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013082no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013083 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013084 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013085 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013086 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013087 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13088 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013089
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013090no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013091 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013092 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013093 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013094 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013095 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13096 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013097
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013098no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013099 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013100 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013101 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013102 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013103 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13104 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013105
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013106no-tlsv13
13107 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13108 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13109 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13110 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013111 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13112 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013113
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013114npn <protocols>
13115 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13116 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13117 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013118 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013119 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013120 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13121 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13122 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13123 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13124 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013125
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013126prefer-client-ciphers
13127 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13128 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13129 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013130 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13131 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13132 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013133
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013134process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013135 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013136 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013137 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013138 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13139 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13140 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13141 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013142 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013143 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13144 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13145 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13146 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13147 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013148
13149 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13150
13151 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13152 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13153 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13154 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13155 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13156 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13157 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13158 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013159
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013160proto <name>
13161 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13162 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13163 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
13164 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013165 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013166 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013167 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013168 h2" on the bind line.
13169
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013170ssl
13171 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013172 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013173 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13174 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013175 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13176 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013177
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013178ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13179 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013180 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13181 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13182 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013183 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13184
13185ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013186 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13187 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13188 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13189 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013190
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013191strict-sni
13192 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13193 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13194 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13195 See the "crt" option for more information.
13196
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013197tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013198 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013199 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13200 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013201 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013202 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13203 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13204 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13205 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13206 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13207 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13208 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13209
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013210tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013211 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013212 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13213 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13214 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13215 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13216 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13217 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13218 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013219 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13220 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13221 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013222
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013223tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13224 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013225 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13226 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13227 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13228 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13229 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13230 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13231 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13232 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13233 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13234 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013235 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13236 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13237
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013238transparent
13239 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13240 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13241 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13242 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13243 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13244 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13245 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13246 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13247 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13248 so check for support with your vendor.
13249
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013250v4v6
13251 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13252 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13253 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13254 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013255 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013256
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013257v6only
13258 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13259 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13260 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013261 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13262 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013263
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013264uid <uid>
13265 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13266 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13267 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13268 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13269 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13270
13271user <user>
13272 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13273 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13274 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13275 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13276 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13277
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013278verify [none|optional|required]
13279 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13280 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13281 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13282 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13283 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013284 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13285 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13286 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13287 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013288
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200132895.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013290------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013291
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013292The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13293which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13294arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13295settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13296after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13297Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13298address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013299
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013300 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013301 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013302
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013303Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13304keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13305
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013306The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013307
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013308addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013309 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013310 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13311 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13312 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13313 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13314 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013315
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013316agent-check
13317 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013318 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013319 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13320 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13321 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013322
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013323 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013324 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013325 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13326 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13327 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013328
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013329 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13330 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13331 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13332 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13333 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013334
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013335 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013336 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013337
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013338 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13339 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13340 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013341
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013342 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13343 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13344 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013345
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013346 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013347 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13348 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13349 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13350 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013351 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013352 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013353
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013354 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13355 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013356
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013357 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13358 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13359 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13360 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13361 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13362 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13363 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13364 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13365 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013366
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013367 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13368 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013369 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13370 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13371 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013372 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013373
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013374 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013375 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013376
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013377agent-send <string>
13378 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13379 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13380 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13381 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13382 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13383
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013384agent-inter <delay>
13385 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13386 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13387
13388 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13389 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13390 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13391 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13392 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13393 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13394 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13395 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13396 of backends use the same servers.
13397
13398 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13399
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013400agent-addr <addr>
13401 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13402
13403 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13404 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13405 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13406 hostname, it will be resolved.
13407
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013408agent-port <port>
13409 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13410
13411 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13412
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013413allow-0rtt
13414 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013415 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13416 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013417
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013418alpn <protocols>
13419 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13420 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13421 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013422 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013423 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13424 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13425 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13426 now obsolete NPN extension.
13427 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13428 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13429
13430 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13431
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013432backup
13433 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13434 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13435 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13436 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013437 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13438 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013439
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013440ca-file <cafile>
13441 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13442 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13443 server's certificate.
13444
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013445check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013446 This option enables health checks on a server:
13447 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13448 considered available.
13449 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13450 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13451 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13452 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13453 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13454 set.
13455 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13456 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13457 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13458 exchanges succeed.
13459
13460 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13461 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13462 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13463 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13464 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013465 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013466 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13467
13468 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13469 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13470
13471 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13472 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13473
13474 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13475 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13476 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13477 available.
13478
13479 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13480 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13481 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13482
13483 Example:
13484 # simple tcp check
13485 backend foo
13486 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13487 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13488 backend foo
13489 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13490 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13491 backend foo
13492 option tcp-check
13493 tcp-check connect
13494 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013495
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013496check-send-proxy
13497 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13498 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13499 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13500 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13501 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13502 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13503 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13504
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013505check-alpn <protocols>
13506 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13507 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13508 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13509
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013510check-proto <name>
13511 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13512 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13513 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13514 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013515 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013516 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13517 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13518
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013519check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013520 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013521 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13522 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013523
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013524check-ssl
13525 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13526 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13527 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13528 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013529 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013530 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13531 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013532 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013533 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13534 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013535
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013536check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013537 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013538 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13539 for normal traffic.
13540
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013541ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013542 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13543 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13544 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013545 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13546 information and recommendations see e.g.
13547 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13548 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13549 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013550
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013551ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13552 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13553 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13554 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13555 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013556 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13557 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13558 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013560cookie <value>
13561 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13562 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13563 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13564 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13565 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13566 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13567 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13568
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013569crl-file <crlfile>
13570 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13571 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13572 to verify server's certificate.
13573
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013574crt <cert>
13575 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13576 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13577 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13578 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13579 certificate request.
13580
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013581disabled
13582 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13583 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13584 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13585 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13586 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013587 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013588
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013589enabled
13590 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13591 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13592 default value.
13593 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13594 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013595
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013596error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013597 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13598 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13599 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013600
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013601 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013602
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013603fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013604 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13605 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13606 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13607
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013608force-sslv3
13609 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13610 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013611 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013612 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013613
13614force-tlsv10
13615 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013616 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013617 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013618
13619force-tlsv11
13620 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013621 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013622 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013623
13624force-tlsv12
13625 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013626 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013627 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013628
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013629force-tlsv13
13630 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13631 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013632 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013633
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013634id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013635 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13636 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13637 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013638
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013639init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13640 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13641 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013642 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013643 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13644 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13645 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13646 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13647 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13648 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13649 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13650 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13651 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013652 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013653 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13654 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13655 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13656 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13657 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13658 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013659 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013660
13661 Example:
13662 defaults
13663 # never fail on address resolution
13664 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13665
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013666inter <delay>
13667fastinter <delay>
13668downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013669 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13670 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13671 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13672 between checks depending on the server state :
13673
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013674 Server state | Interval used
13675 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13676 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13677 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13678 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13679 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13680 or yet unchecked. |
13681 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13682 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13683 | "inter" otherwise.
13684 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013685
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013686 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13687 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13688 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13689 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013690 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13691 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13692 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13693 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13694 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013695
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013696log-proto <logproto>
13697 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13698 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13699 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13700 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13701
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013702maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013703 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13704 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013705 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13706 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013707 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13708 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13709 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13710 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13711
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013712 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13713 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13714 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13715 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13716 than 50 concurrent requests.
13717
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013718maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013719 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13720 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13721 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13722 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020013723 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
13724 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
13725 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
13726 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
13727 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
13728 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
13729 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013730
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013731max-reuse <count>
13732 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13733 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13734 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13735 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13736 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13737 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13738 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13739 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013741minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013742 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13743 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13744 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13745 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13746 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13747 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013748 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013749 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013750
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013751namespace <name>
13752 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13753 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13754 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13755 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13756
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013757no-agent-check
13758 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13759 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13760 default value.
13761 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13762 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13763
13764no-backup
13765 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13766 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13767 default value.
13768 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13769 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13770
13771no-check
13772 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13773 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13774 default value.
13775 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13776 "default-server" "check" setting.
13777
13778no-check-ssl
13779 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13780 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13781 default value.
13782 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13783 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13784
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013785no-send-proxy
13786 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13787 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13788 default value.
13789 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13790 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13791
13792no-send-proxy-v2
13793 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13794 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13795 default value.
13796 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13797 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13798
13799no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13800 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13801 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13802 default value.
13803 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13804 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13805
13806no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13807 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13808 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13809 default value.
13810 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13811 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13812
13813no-ssl
13814 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13815 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13816 default value.
13817 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13818 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13819
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013820no-ssl-reuse
13821 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13822 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13823 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13824 and for paranoid users.
13825
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013826no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013827 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13828 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013829 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013830
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013831 Supported in default-server: No
13832
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013833no-tls-tickets
13834 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13835 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13836 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013837 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13838 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013839 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13840 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13841 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013842 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013843
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013844no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013845 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013846 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13847 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013848 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13849 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013850 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013851
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013852 Supported in default-server: No
13853
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013854no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013855 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013856 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13857 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013858 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13859 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013860 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013861
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013862 Supported in default-server: No
13863
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013864no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013865 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013866 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13867 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013868 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13869 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013870 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013871
13872 Supported in default-server: No
13873
13874no-tlsv13
13875 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13876 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13877 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13878 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13879 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013880 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013881
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013882 Supported in default-server: No
13883
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013884no-verifyhost
13885 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13886 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13887 default value.
13888 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13889 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013890
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013891no-tfo
13892 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13893 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13894 default value.
13895 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13896 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13897
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013898non-stick
13899 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13900 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13901 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13902
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013903npn <protocols>
13904 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13905 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13906 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013907 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013908 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13909 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13910 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13911
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013912observe <mode>
13913 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13914 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13915 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13916 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13917 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13918 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013919 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013920
13921 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13922
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013923on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013924 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13925 Currently, four modes are available:
13926 - fastinter: force fastinter
13927 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13928 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13929 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13930 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13931
13932 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13933
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013934on-marked-down <action>
13935 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13936 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013937 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13938 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13939 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13940 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13941 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13942 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13943 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13944 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013945
13946 Actions are disabled by default
13947
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013948on-marked-up <action>
13949 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13950 Currently one action is available:
13951 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13952 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13953 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13954 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013955 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13956 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013957 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13958 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13959
13960 Actions are disabled by default
13961
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013962pool-low-conn <max>
13963 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13964 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13965 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13966 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13967 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13968 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13969 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13970 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13971 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13972 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
13973 applying to "http-reuse".
13974
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013975pool-max-conn <max>
13976 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13977 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13978 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13979 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13980 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13981 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13982
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013983pool-purge-delay <delay>
13984 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013985 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013986 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013987
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013988port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013989 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13990 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13991 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13992 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13993 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13994 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13995
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013996proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013997 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13998 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13999 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
14000 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014001 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014002 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014004redir <prefix>
14005 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14006 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14007 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14008 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14009 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14010 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14011 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14012 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014013 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014014 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014015 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14016 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14017 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14018 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14019
14020 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14021
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014022rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014023 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14024 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14025 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14026
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014027resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14028 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14029 server.
14030
14031 Available options:
14032
14033 * allow-dup-ip
14034 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14035 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14036 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14037 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14038 For such case, simply enable this option.
14039 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14040
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014041 * ignore-weight
14042 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14043 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14044 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14045
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014046 * prevent-dup-ip
14047 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14048 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14049 same fqdn.
14050 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14051
14052 Example:
14053 backend b_myapp
14054 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14055 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14056 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14057
14058 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14059 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14060 it
14061 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14062 different address
14063
14064 Default value: not set
14065
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014066resolve-prefer <family>
14067 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14068 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14069 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14070 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14071
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014072 Default value: ipv6
14073
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014074 Example:
14075
14076 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014077
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014078resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014079 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014080 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014081 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014082 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14083 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014084 configured network, another address is selected.
14085
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014086 Example:
14087
14088 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014089
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014090resolvers <id>
14091 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14092 hostname.
14093
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014094 Example:
14095
14096 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014097
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014098 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014099
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014100send-proxy
14101 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14102 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14103 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14104 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014105 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14106 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14107 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14108 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14109 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14110 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14111 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14112 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14113 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14114 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014115 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14116 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014117
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014118send-proxy-v2
14119 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14120 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14121 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14122 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014123 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14124 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14125 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14126 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014127
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014128proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014129 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14130 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14131
14132 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14133 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14134 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14135 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14136 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14137 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14138 connection is supported).
14139 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14140 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14141 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14142 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14143 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14144 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14145 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014146
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014147send-proxy-v2-ssl
14148 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14149 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14150 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14151 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14152 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14153 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14154 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014155 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14156 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014157
14158send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14159 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14160 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14161 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14162 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14163 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14164 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14165 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14166 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014167 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14168 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014169
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014170slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014171 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14172 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14173 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14174 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14175 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14176 parameters :
14177
14178 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14179 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14180
14181 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14182 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14183 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14184 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14185
14186 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14187 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14188 seen as failed.
14189
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014190sni <expression>
14191 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14192 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14193 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14194 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014195 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14196 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014197 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014198 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14199 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014200
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014201source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014202source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014203source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014204 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14205 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14206 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14207 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14208
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014209 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14210 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14211 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14212 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14213 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14214 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14215 server.
14216
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014217 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14218 specifying the source address without port(s).
14219
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014220ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014221 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14222 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14223 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14224 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14225 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14226 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014227 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14228 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014229
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014230ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14231 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14232 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14233 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14234
14235ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14236 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14237 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14238 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14239
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014240ssl-reuse
14241 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14242 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14243 default value.
14244 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14245 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14246
14247stick
14248 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14249 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14250 default value.
14251 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14252 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014253
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014254socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014255 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014256 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14257 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14258
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014259tcp-ut <delay>
14260 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14261 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14262 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014263 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014264 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14265 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14266 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14267 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14268 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14269 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14270 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14271 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14272 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14273
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014274tfo
14275 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14276 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14277 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14278 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14279 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014280 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014282track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014283 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14284 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14285 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14286 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014287 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14288
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014289tls-tickets
14290 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14291 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14292 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014293 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14294 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14295 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014296 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014297 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014298
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014299verify [none|required]
14300 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014301 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014302 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14303 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014304 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014305 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14306 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14307 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14308 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14309 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14310 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14311 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14312 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014313
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014314verifyhost <hostname>
14315 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014316 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14317 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14318 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14319 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14320 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14321 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14322 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14323 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014324
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014325weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014326 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14327 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14328 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014329 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14330 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14331 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14332 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14333 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14334 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014335
14336
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143375.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14338-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014339
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014340HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14341using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombsdab4ba62021-01-07 21:24:41 -070014342configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014343This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14344can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14345workload.
14346This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14347resolution at run time.
14348Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14349carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14350
14351
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143525.3.1. Global overview
14353----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014354
14355As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14356different steps of the process life:
14357
14358 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14359 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14360 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14361
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014362 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14363 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014364
14365A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14366 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14367 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14368 resolution to know this new IP.
14369
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014370When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014371HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014372SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14373from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14374will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14375will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014376
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014377A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014378 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014379 first valid response.
14380
14381 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14382 servers return an error.
14383
14384
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143855.3.2. The resolvers section
14386----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014387
14388This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014389HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14390contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014391
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014392When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14393uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14394is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14395answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14396
14397When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014398used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014399
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014400 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14401 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14402 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014403
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014404 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14405 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014406
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014407 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14408 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14409 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014410
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014411For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14412following scenarios are possible:
14413
14414 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14415 ignored
14416
14417 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14418 applied
14419
14420 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14421 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14422
14423 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14424 retries the query with a new type
14425
14426 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14427 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014428
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014429As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14430a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014431<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014432
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014433
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014434resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014435 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014436
14437A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14438
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014439accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014440 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014441 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014442 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14443 by RFC 6891)
14444
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014445 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14446
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014447nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14448 DNS server description:
14449 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14450 <ip> : IP address of the server
14451 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14452
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014453parse-resolv-conf
14454 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14455 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14456 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14457
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014458hold <status> <period>
14459 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14460 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014461 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014462 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014463 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14464 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14465 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14466
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014467 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014468
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014469resolve_retries <nb>
14470 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14471 giving up.
14472 Default value: 3
14473
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014474 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14475 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14476 type.
14477
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014478timeout <event> <time>
14479 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14480 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14481 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014482 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14483 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014484 Default value: 1s
14485 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014486 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014487 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014488 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14489 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14490
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014491 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014492
14493 resolvers mydns
14494 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14495 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014496 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014497 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014498 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014499 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014500 hold other 30s
14501 hold refused 30s
14502 hold nx 30s
14503 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014504 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014505 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014506
14507
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200145086. Cache
14509---------
14510
14511HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14512(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14513RAM.
14514
14515The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14516this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14517
14518If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14519independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14520when we try to allocate a new one.
14521
14522The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14523
14524It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14525"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14526for more details.
14527
14528When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14529replaced by "<CACHE>".
14530
14531
145326.1. Limitation
14533----------------
14534
14535The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14536
14537- If the response is not a 200
14538- If the response contains a Vary header
14539- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14540- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonea8e0812020-11-26 15:51:29 +010014541- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
14542 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
14543 headers)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014544
14545- If the request is not a GET
14546- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14547- If the request contains an Authorization header
14548
14549
145506.2. Setup
14551-----------
14552
14553To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14554the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14555
14556
145576.2.1. Cache section
14558---------------------
14559
14560cache <name>
14561 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14562 size of cache is mandatory.
14563
14564total-max-size <megabytes>
14565 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14566 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14567
14568max-object-size <bytes>
14569 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14570 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14571 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14572
14573max-age <seconds>
14574 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14575 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14576 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14577 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14578 default.
14579
14580
145816.2.2. Proxy section
14582---------------------
14583
14584http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14585 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14586 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14587 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14588 after this one.
14589
14590http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14591 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14592 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14593 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14594 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14595
14596
14597Example:
14598
14599 backend bck1
14600 mode http
14601
14602 http-request cache-use foobar
14603 http-response cache-store foobar
14604 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14605
14606 cache foobar
14607 total-max-size 4
14608 max-age 240
14609
14610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146117. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14612----------------------------------
14613
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014614HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014615client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14616The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14617these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14618but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14619data called patterns.
14620
14621
146227.1. ACL basics
14623---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014624
14625The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14626content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14627from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14628simple :
14629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014630 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014631 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014632 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14633 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014635The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14636adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014637
14638In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014640 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014641
14642This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14643Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14644and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014645an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14646conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14647as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14648are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014649
14650ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14651'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14652which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14653
14654There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14655performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014657The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14658specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14659this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014660methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14661ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014662
14663Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14664 - boolean
14665 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14666 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14667 - string
14668 - data block
14669
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014670Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14671converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14672would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14673The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14674which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14675
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014676Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14677keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14678fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14679which are summarized in the table below :
14680
14681 +---------------------+-----------------+
14682 | Sample or converter | Default |
14683 | output type | matching method |
14684 +---------------------+-----------------+
14685 | boolean | bool |
14686 +---------------------+-----------------+
14687 | integer | int |
14688 +---------------------+-----------------+
14689 | ip | ip |
14690 +---------------------+-----------------+
14691 | string | str |
14692 +---------------------+-----------------+
14693 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14694 +---------------------+-----------------+
14695
14696Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14697matching method, see below.
14698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014699The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14700 - boolean
14701 - integer or integer range
14702 - IP address / network
14703 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14704 - regular expression
14705 - hex block
14706
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014707The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14708
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014709 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14710 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014711 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014712 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014713 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014714 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014715 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014717The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14718read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14719if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14720lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14721will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14722beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14723a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14724lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14725exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14726
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014727The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14728parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14729ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14730a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14731check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14732
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014733The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14734socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14735file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014737Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14738loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14739
14740 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14741
14742In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14743the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14744case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14745as well.
14746
14747The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14748sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14749do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14750methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14751is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014752obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014753followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14754default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14755that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14756string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14757
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014758The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14759By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14760string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14761resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14762server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014763waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014764flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14765function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014767There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14768sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14769be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014770
14771 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14772 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014773 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14774 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14775 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14776 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014777
14778 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14779 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014780 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014781
14782 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014783 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014784
14785 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014786 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014787
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014788 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014789 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14790
14791 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14792 binary or string samples.
14793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014794 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14795 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014797 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14798 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14799 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014801 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14802 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014804 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14805 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014807 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14808 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014810 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14811 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014812 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014814 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14815 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14816 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014817
14818For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14819request, it is possible to do :
14820
14821 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14822
14823In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14824buffer, one would use the following acl :
14825
14826 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14827
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014828On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14829possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14830
14831 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014833All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14834criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14835method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14836to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14837criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14838the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014840If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014841the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14842For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014844 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14845 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14846 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14847 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014848
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014849
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014850The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14851types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14852combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14853brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14854default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014856 +-------------------------------------------------+
14857 | Input sample type |
14858 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014859 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014860 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14861 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14862 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014863 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014864 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014865 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014866 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014867 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014868 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014869 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014870 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014871 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014872 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014873 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014874 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014875 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014876 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014877 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014878 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014879 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014880 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014881 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014882 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014883 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014884 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14885 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14886 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014887
14888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200148897.1.1. Matching booleans
14890------------------------
14891
14892In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14893Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14894When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14895that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14896
14897Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14898return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14899"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14900
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149027.1.2. Matching integers
14903------------------------
14904
14905Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14906enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14907to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14908
14909Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14910matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14911lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014912
14913For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14914unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14915representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14916
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014917As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14918two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14919instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14920ranges and operators.
14921
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014922For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014923operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14924Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14925of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014926
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014927Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014928
14929 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14930 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14931 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14932 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14933 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14934
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014935For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014936
14937 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14938
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014939This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14940
14941 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14942
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149447.1.3. Matching strings
14945-----------------------
14946
14947String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14948different forms :
14949
14950 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014951 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014952
14953 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014954 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014955
14956 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14957 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14958
14959 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14960 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14961
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014962 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014963 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14964 matches.
14965
14966 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14967 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14968 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014969
14970String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14971exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14972characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14973string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14974to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014975before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014976
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014977Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14978(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14979Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14980
14981Example:
14982 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14983 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14984
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149867.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14987---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014988
14989Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14990they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14991possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14992passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14993the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014994the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14995match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014996
14997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149987.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14999-------------------------------------
15000
15001It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15002not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15003a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15004to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15005digits may be used upper or lower case.
15006
15007Example :
15008 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15009 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15010
15011
150127.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15013---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015014
15015IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15016netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15017within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015018host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015019difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15020at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15021does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15022parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015023
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015024The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15025abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15026
15027 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15028 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15029 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15030 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15031 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15032 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15033 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15034 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15035
15036Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15037192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15038
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015039IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15040Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15041trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15042IPv6 patterns.
15043
15044HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15045following situations :
15046 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15047 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15048 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15049 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15050 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15051 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15052 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15053 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15054 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15055 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015057
150587.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15059----------------------------------
15060
15061Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15062combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15063
15064 - AND (implicit)
15065 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15066 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015068A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015070 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015072Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15073indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015075For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15076"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15077requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15078is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15079
15080 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015081 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15082 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15083 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015084
15085To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15086and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15087
15088 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15089 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15090 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15091 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15092
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015093 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015094 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15095 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15096 use_backend www if host_www
15097
15098It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15099expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15100be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15101the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15102
15103 The following rule :
15104
15105 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015106 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015107
15108 Can also be written that way :
15109
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015110 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015111
15112It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15113to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15114simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15115sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15116good use is the following :
15117
15118 With named ACLs :
15119
15120 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15121 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15122 monitor fail if site_dead
15123
15124 With anonymous ACLs :
15125
15126 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15127
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015128See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15129keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015130
15131
151327.3. Fetching samples
15133---------------------
15134
15135Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15136against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15137sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15138ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15139of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15140available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15141
15142This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15143Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15144compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15145deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15146
15147The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15148matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15149method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15150indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15151
15152As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15153when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15154mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15155the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15156ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15157
15158Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15159multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15160when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015161incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15162are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015163is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15164all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15165
15166Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15167 - name
15168 - name(arg1)
15169 - name(arg1,arg2)
15170
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015171
151727.3.1. Converters
15173-----------------
15174
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015175Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15176of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15177is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15178was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015179has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015180unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15181
15182These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15183sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15184the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015185support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015186
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015187A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15188support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15189supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15190(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15191bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015193The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015194
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001519551d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15196 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15197 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15198 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15199 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15200 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15201
15202 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015203 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15204 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015205 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15206 frontend http-in
15207 bind *:8081
15208 default_backend servers
15209 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15210 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15211
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015212add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015213 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015214 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015215 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15216 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015217 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015218 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15219 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15220 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15221 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015222 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015223 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015224
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015225aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15226 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15227 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15228 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15229 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15230 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15231 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15232
15233 Example:
15234 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15235 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15236
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015237and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015238 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015239 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015240 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15241 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015242 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015243 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15244 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15245 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15246 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015247 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015248 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015249
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015250b64dec
15251 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15252 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
15253
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015254base64
15255 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015256 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015257 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
15258
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015259bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015260 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015261 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015262 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015263 presence of a flag).
15264
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015265bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15266 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15267 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015268 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015269
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015270concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15271 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15272 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15273 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15274 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15275 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15276 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15277 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15278 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15279 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15280 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015281 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015282 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015283 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15284 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015285
15286 Example:
15287 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15288 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15289 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015290 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015291 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15292
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015293cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015294 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15295 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015296
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015297crc32([<avalanche>])
15298 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15299 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15300 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15301 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15302 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15303 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15304 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15305 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15306 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15307 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015308 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15309
15310crc32c([<avalanche>])
15311 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15312 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15313 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15314 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15315 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15316 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15317 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15318 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015319
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015320cut_crlf
15321 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15322 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15323 updated.
15324
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015325da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015326 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15327 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15328 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15329 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015330 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015331 configuration language.
15332
15333 Example:
15334 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015335 bind *:8881
15336 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015337 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015338
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015339debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15340 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15341 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15342 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15343 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15344 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15345 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15346 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15347 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15348 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15349 printable sample types.
15350
15351 Example:
15352 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015353
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015354digest(<algorithm>)
15355 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15356 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15357
15358 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15359 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15360
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015361div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015362 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15363 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015364 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015365 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15366 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015367 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015368 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15369 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15370 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15371 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015372 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015373 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015374
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015375djb2([<avalanche>])
15376 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15377 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15378 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15379 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15380 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15381 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15382 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015383 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15384 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015385
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015386even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015387 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015388 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15389
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015390field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15391 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15392 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15393 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15394 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15395 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15396 fields.
15397
15398 Example :
15399 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15400 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15401 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15402 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15403 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015404
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015405hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015406 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015407 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015408 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015409 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015410
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015411hex2i
15412 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015413 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015414
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015415htonl
15416 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15417 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15418 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15419 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15420
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015421hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
15422 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15423 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15424 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15425 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15426
15427 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15428 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15429
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015430http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015431 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15432 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015433 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15434 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15435 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15436 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15437 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15438 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15439 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15440 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015441
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015442iif(<true>,<false>)
15443 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15444 string otherwise.
15445
15446 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015447 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015448
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015449in_table(<table>)
15450 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15451 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15452 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015453 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015454 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15455
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015456ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
15457 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015458 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015459 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15460 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15461 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15462 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15463 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015464
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015465json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015466 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015467 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015468 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015469 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15470 of errors:
15471 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15472 bytes, ...)
15473 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15474 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15475
15476 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15477 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15478 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15479 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15480 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15481 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015482 - "ascii" : never fails;
15483 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15484 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015485 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015486 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015487 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15488 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15489
15490 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015491 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015492
15493 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015494 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015495 capture request header user-agent len 150
15496 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015497
15498 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15499 GET / HTTP/1.0
15500 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15501
15502 Output log:
15503 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15504
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015505language(<value>[,<default>])
15506 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15507 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15508 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15509 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15510 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15511 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15512 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15513 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15514 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015515 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015516 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15517 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015518
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015519 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015520
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015521 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15522 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015523
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015524 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15525 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15526 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15527 use_backend spanish if es
15528 use_backend french if fr
15529 use_backend english if en
15530 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015531
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015532length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015533 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15534 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15535 type. The result is of type integer.
15536
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015537lower
15538 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15539 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15540 type. The result is of type string.
15541
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015542ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15543 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15544 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15545 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15546 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15547 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15548 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15549
15550 Example :
15551
15552 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015553 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015554 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15555
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015556ltrim(<chars>)
15557 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15558 representation of the input sample.
15559
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015560map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15561map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15562map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15563 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15564 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15565 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15566 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15567 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15568 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15569 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15570 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015571
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015572 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15573 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15574 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015575
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015576 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015577 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015578
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015579 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15580 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15581 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15582 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015583 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15584 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015585 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15586 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15587 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15588 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15589 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15590 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15591 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15592 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015593 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15594 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15595 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015596 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15597 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15598 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15599 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15600 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015601
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015602 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15603 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15604 the corresponding match text.
15605
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015606 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15607 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15608 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15609 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15610 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015611
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015612 Example :
15613
15614 # this is a comment and is ignored
15615 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15616 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15617 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15618 | | | `---------- value
15619 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15620 | `---------------------------- key
15621 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15622
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015623mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015624 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15625 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015626 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015627 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015628 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015629 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15630 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15631 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15632 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015633 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015634 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015635
15636mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015637 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015638 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15639 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015640 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015641 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015642 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015643 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15644 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15645 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15646 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015647 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015648 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015649
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015650nbsrv
15651 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15652 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15653 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15654 map lookup.
15655
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015656neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015657 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15658 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15659 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15660 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015661
15662not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015663 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015664 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015665 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015666 absence of a flag).
15667
15668odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015669 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015670 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15671
15672or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015673 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015674 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015675 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15676 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015677 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015678 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15679 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15680 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15681 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015682 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015683 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015684
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015685protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15686 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15687 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15688 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15689 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15690 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15691 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15692 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15693 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15694 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15695 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15696 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15697
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015698regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015699 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15700 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15701 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15702 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15703 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15704 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15705 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15706 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15707 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015708 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15709 of characters with other ones.
15710
15711 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15712 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15713 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15714 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15715 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15716 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015717
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015718 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015719
15720 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15721 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15722 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015723 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015724
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015725 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15726 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15727
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015728 # capture groups and backreferences
15729 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020015730 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015731 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15732
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015733capture-req(<id>)
15734 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15735 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15736
15737 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015738 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15739 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015740
15741capture-res(<id>)
15742 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15743 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15744
15745 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015746 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15747 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015748
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015749rtrim(<chars>)
15750 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15751 of the input sample.
15752
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015753sdbm([<avalanche>])
15754 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15755 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15756 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15757 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15758 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15759 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15760 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015761 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15762 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015763
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015764secure_memcmp(<var>)
15765 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15766 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15767 match.
15768
15769 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15770 performed in constant time.
15771
15772 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15773 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15774
15775 Example :
15776
15777 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15778 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15779 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15780 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15781
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015782set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015783 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15784 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15785 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015786 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015787 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15788 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015789 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015790 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15791 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015792 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015793 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015794
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015795sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015796 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015797 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15798
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015799sha2([<bits>])
15800 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15801 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15802
15803 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15804 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15805
15806 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15807 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15808
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015809srv_queue
15810 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15811 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15812 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15813 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15814 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15815
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015816strcmp(<var>)
15817 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15818 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15819 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15820 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15821 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15822 shorter).
15823
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015824 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15825 strings in constant time.
15826
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015827 Example :
15828
15829 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15830 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15831 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15832
15833
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015834sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015835 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15836 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015837 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015838 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15839 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015840 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015841 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15842 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015843 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015844 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15845 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015846 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015847 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015848
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015849table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15850 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15851 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15852 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15853 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15854 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15855 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15856
15857
15858table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15859 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15860 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15861 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15862 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15863 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15864 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15865
15866table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15867 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15868 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015869 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015870 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15871 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15872
15873table_conn_cur(<table>)
15874 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15875 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15876 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15877 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15878 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15879
15880table_conn_rate(<table>)
15881 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15882 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15883 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15884 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15885 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15886
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015887table_gpt0(<table>)
15888 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15889 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15890 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15891 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15892 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15893
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015894table_gpc0(<table>)
15895 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15896 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15897 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15898 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15899 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15900
15901table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15902 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15903 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15904 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15905 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15906 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15907 sample fetch keyword.
15908
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015909table_gpc1(<table>)
15910 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15911 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15912 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15913 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15914 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15915
15916table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15917 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15918 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15919 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15920 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15921 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15922 sample fetch keyword.
15923
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015924table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15925 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15926 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015927 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015928 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15929 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15930
15931table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15932 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15933 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15934 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15935 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15936 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15937 keyword.
15938
15939table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15940 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15941 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015942 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015943 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15944 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15945
15946table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15947 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15948 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15949 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15950 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15951 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15952 keyword.
15953
15954table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15955 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15956 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015957 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015958 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15959 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15960 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15961 keyword.
15962
15963table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15964 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15965 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015966 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015967 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15968 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15969 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15970 keyword.
15971
15972table_server_id(<table>)
15973 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15974 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15975 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15976 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15977 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15978 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15979
15980table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15981 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15982 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015983 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015984 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15985 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15986 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15987 keyword.
15988
15989table_sess_rate(<table>)
15990 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15991 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15992 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15993 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15994 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15995 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15996 keyword.
15997
15998table_trackers(<table>)
15999 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16000 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16001 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16002 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16003 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16004 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16005 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16006 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16007 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16008 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16009
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016010upper
16011 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16012 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16013 type. The result is of type string.
16014
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016015url_dec([<in_form>])
16016 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16017 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16018 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16019 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16020 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16021 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016022
William Dauchy55ed7c42021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016023url_enc([<enc_type>])
16024 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16025 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16026 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16027 optional argument is here for future changes.
16028
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016029ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016030 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016031 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16032 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16033 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016034 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16035 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16036 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16037 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016038 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016039 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16040 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016041
16042 Example:
16043 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16044 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16045
16046 message Point {
16047 int32 latitude = 1;
16048 int32 longitude = 2;
16049 }
16050
16051 message PPoint {
16052 Point point = 59;
16053 }
16054
16055 message Rectangle {
16056 // One corner of the rectangle.
16057 PPoint lo = 48;
16058 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16059 PPoint hi = 49;
16060 }
16061
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016062 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16063 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16064 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016065
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016066 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16067 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016068 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016069 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16070
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016071 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016072
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016073 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016074
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016075 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16076 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16077 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016078
16079 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16080 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16081 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16082
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016083 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16084 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16085 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016086
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016087
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016088unset-var(<var name>)
16089 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16090 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16091 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16092 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16093 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16094 response),
16095 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16096 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16097 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16098 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16099
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016100utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16101 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16102 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16103 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16104 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16105 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16106 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16107
16108 Example :
16109
16110 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016111 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016112 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16113
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016114word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16115 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16116 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16117 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016118 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016119 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16120 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16121
16122 Example :
16123 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16124 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16125 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16126 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16127 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016128 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016129
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016130wt6([<avalanche>])
16131 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16132 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16133 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16134 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16135 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16136 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16137 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016138 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16139 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016140
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016141xor(<value>)
16142 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016143 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016144 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016145 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016146 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016147 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16148 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016149 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016150 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16151 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016152 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016153 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016154
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016155xxh32([<seed>])
16156 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16157 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16158 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16159 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16160 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16161 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16162 as cryptographically secure.
16163
16164xxh64([<seed>])
16165 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16166 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16167 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16168 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16169 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16170 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16171 as cryptographically secure.
16172
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016173
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200161747.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016175--------------------------------------------
16176
16177A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
16178not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
16179"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
16180The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
16181
16182always_false : boolean
16183 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16184 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16185
16186always_true : boolean
16187 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16188 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16189
16190avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016191 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016192 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
16193 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
16194 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
16195 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
16196 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
16197 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
16198 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
16199 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
16200 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
16201 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
16202 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
16203 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
16204 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010016205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016206be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016207 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
16208 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
16209 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
16210 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016211 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
16212
16213be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
16214 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16215 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
16216 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
16217 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
16218 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016219 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
16220 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016221
16222 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
16223 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
16224 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016226be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
16227 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16228 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16229 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016230 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016231 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
16232 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016233
16234 Example :
16235 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
16236 backend dynamic
16237 mode http
16238 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
16239 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016240
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016241bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016242 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
16243 of the string.
16244
16245bool(<bool>) : bool
16246 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
16247 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
16248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016249connslots([<backend>]) : integer
16250 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016251 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016252 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
16253 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050016254
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016255 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016256 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016257 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
16258
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016259 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
16260 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016261
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016262 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016263 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016264 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016265 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016266 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016267 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016268 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016269
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016270 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
16271 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016272 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016273 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016274
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016275cpu_calls : integer
16276 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
16277 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
16278 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
16279 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
16280 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
16281 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
16282
16283cpu_ns_avg : integer
16284 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16285 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16286 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16287 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16288 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16289 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16290 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16291 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16292 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16293 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16294 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16295
16296cpu_ns_tot : integer
16297 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16298 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16299 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16300 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16301 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16302 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16303 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16304 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16305 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16306 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16307 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16308 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16309 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16310
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016311date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016312 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016313
16314 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16315 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16316 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016317 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16318
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016319 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16320 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16321 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16322 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16323 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16324
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016325 Example :
16326
16327 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16328 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016329
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016330 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16331 # millisecond granularity
16332 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16333
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016334date_us : integer
16335 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16336 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16337 from the same timeval structure.
16338
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016339distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16340 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16341 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16342 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16343 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16344 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16345 list of supported tokens.
16346
16347distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16348 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16349 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16350 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16351 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16352 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16353 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16354 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16355 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16356 supported tokens.
16357
16358 Example :
16359 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16360 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16361 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16362 # send large files to the big farm
16363 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16364
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016365env(<name>) : string
16366 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16367 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16368 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16369 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16370 certain way.
16371
16372 Examples :
16373 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16374 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16375
16376 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16377 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016379fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16380 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016381 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16382 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016383 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16384 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016385 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016386 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16387 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016388
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016389fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16390 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16391 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16392 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016394fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16395 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16396 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16397 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16398 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16399 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16400 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16401 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16402 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016403
16404 Example :
16405 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16406 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16407 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16408 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16409 frontend mail
16410 bind :25
16411 mode tcp
16412 maxconn 100
16413 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16414 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16415 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16416 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016417
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016418hostname : string
16419 Returns the system hostname.
16420
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016421int(<integer>) : signed integer
16422 Returns a signed integer.
16423
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016424ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16425 Returns an ipv4.
16426
16427ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16428 Returns an ipv6.
16429
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016430lat_ns_avg : integer
16431 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16432 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16433 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16434 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16435 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16436 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16437 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16438 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16439 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016440 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16441 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16442 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16443 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16444 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16445 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016446
16447lat_ns_tot : integer
16448 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16449 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16450 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16451 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16452 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16453 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16454 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16455 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16456 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016457 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16458 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16459 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16460 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16461 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016462 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16463 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16464 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16465 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16466 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16467 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16468
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016469meth(<method>) : method
16470 Returns a method.
16471
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016472nbproc : integer
16473 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16474 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16475 and debugging purposes.
16476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016477nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16478 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16479 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16480 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016481 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16482 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16483 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016484
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016485prio_class : integer
16486 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16487 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16488 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16489
16490prio_offset : integer
16491 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16492 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16493 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16494 set-priority-offset".
16495
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016496proc : integer
16497 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16498 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16499 debugging purposes.
16500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016501queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016502 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16503 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16504 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016505 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16506 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16507 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16508 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16509 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16510
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016511rand([<range>]) : integer
16512 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16513 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16514 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16515 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16516 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16517
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016518uuid([<version>]) : string
16519 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16520 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16521 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016523srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16524 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16525 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16526 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16527 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16528 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016529 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16530 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16531
16532srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16533 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16534 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16535 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16536 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16537 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16538 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16539 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16540
16541 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16542 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016543
16544srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16545 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16546 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16547 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016548 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016549 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16550 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16551 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16552
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016553srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16554 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16555 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16556 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16557 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16558 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16559 fetch methods.
16560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016561srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16562 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16563 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016564 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016565 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16566 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016567 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016568 overloading servers).
16569
16570 Example :
16571 # Redirect to a separate back
16572 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16573 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16574 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16575
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016576srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16577 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16578 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16579 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16580
16581srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16582 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16583 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16584 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16585
16586srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16587 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16588 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16589 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16590
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016591stopping : boolean
16592 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16593 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16594 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16595
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016596str(<string>) : string
16597 Returns a string.
16598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016599table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16600 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16601 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16602
16603table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16604 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16605 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16606 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16607
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016608thread : integer
16609 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16610 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16611 and debugging purposes.
16612
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016613var(<var-name>) : undefined
16614 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016615 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16616 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016617 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016618 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16619 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016620 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016621 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16622 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016623 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016624 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016625
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200166267.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016627----------------------------------
16628
16629The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16630closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16631methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16632sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16633TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016634the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16635counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016636"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16637used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16638can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16639Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16640table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16641tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16642currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016643
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016644bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016645 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16646 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16647 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016649be_id : integer
16650 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016651 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16652 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016653
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016654be_name : string
16655 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016656 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16657 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016659dst : ip
16660 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16661 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16662 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16663 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016664 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16665 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16666 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16667 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16668 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16669 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016670
16671dst_conn : integer
16672 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16673 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16674 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16675 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16676 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16677 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16678 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16679 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016680
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016681dst_is_local : boolean
16682 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16683 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16684 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16685 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016686 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016687 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16688 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16689 it only once per connection.
16690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016691dst_port : integer
16692 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16693 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16694 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16695 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16696 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16697 an HTTP header.
16698
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016699fc_http_major : integer
16700 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16701 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16702 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16703
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016704fc_pp_authority : string
16705 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16706 if any.
16707
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016708fc_pp_unique_id : string
16709 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16710 if any.
16711
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016712fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16713 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16714 header.
16715
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016716fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16717 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16718 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16719 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16720 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16721 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16722 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16723
16724fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16725 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16726 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16727 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16728 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16729 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16730 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16731
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016732fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016733 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16734 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16735 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16736 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16737
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016738fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016739 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16740 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16741 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16742 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16743
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016744fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016745 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16746 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16747 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16748 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16749
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016750fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016751 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16752 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16753 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16754 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16755
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016756fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016757 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16758 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16759 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16760 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16761
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016762fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016763 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16764 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16765 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16766 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16767
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016768fe_defbe : string
16769 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16770 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016772fe_id : integer
16773 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016774 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016775 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16776
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016777fe_name : string
16778 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16779 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16780 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16781
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016782sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016783sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16784sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16785sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016786 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16787 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16788 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16789
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016790sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016791sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16792sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16793sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016794 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16795 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16796 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16797
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016798sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016799sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16800sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16801sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016802 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16803 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016804 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16805 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16806 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016807
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016808 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016809 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16810 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016811 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16812 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16813 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016814 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16815 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16816
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016817sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16818sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16819sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16820sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16821 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16822 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16823 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16824 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16825 when a first ACL was verified.
16826
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016827sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016828sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16829sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16830sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016831 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016832 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16833
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016834sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016835sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16836sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16837sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016838 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16839 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16840 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16841
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016842sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016843sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16844sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16845sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016846 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16847 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16848 See also src_conn_rate.
16849
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016850sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016851sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16852sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16853sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016854 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016855 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016856
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016857sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16858sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16859sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16860sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16861 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16862 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16863
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016864sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16865sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16866sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16867sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16868 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16869 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16870
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016871sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016872sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16873sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16874sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016875 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16876 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16877 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016878 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16879 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16880 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016881
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016882sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16883sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16884sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16885sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16886 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16887 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16888 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16889 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16890 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16891 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16892
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016893sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016894sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16895sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16896sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016897 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016898 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16899 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16900
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016901sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016902sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16903sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16904sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016905 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16906 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16907 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16908 src_http_err_rate.
16909
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016910sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016911sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16912sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16913sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016914 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016915 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16916 src_http_req_cnt.
16917
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016918sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016919sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16920sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16921sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016922 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16923 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16924 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16925 src_http_req_rate.
16926
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016927sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016928sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16929sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16930sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016931 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016932 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16933 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16934 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16935 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016936
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016937 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016938 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16939 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016940 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16941
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016942sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16943sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16944sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16945sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16946 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16947 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16948 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16949 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16950 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16951
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016952sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016953sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16954sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16955sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016956 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16957 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16958 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016959
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016960sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016961sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16962sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16963sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016964 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16965 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16966 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016967
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016968sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016969sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16970sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16971sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016972 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016973 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16974 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16975 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016976 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016977 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16978
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016979sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016980sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16981sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16982sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016983 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16984 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16985 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16986 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16987 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016988 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016989
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016990sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016991sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16992sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16993sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016994 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16995 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16996 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16997
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016998sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016999sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17000sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17001sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017002 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17003 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017004 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017005 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17006 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017007 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17008 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17009 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017011so_id : integer
17012 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17013 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17014 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017015
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017016so_name : string
17017 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17018 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17019 strings instead of integers.
17020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017021src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017022 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017023 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17024 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17025 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017026 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17027 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17028 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017029 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17030 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17031 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17032 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17033 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17034 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17035 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017036
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017037 Example:
17038 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17039 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017041src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17042 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17043 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17044 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017045 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017047src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17048 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17049 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017050 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017051 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017053src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17054 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17055 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17056 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17057 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17058 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17059 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017060
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017061 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017062 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17063 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17064 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17065 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017066 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017067 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17068 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17069
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017070src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17071 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17072 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17073 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17074 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17075 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17076 was verified.
17077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017078src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017079 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017080 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017081 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017082 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017084src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017085 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017086 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17087 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017088 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017090src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17091 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
17092 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17093 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017094 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017096src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017097 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017098 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017099 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017100 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017101
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017102src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17103 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17104 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17105 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17106 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
17107
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017108src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17109 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17110 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17111 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17112 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
17113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017114src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017115 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017116 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017117 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17118 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017119 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17120 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17121 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017122
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017123src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17124 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17125 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17126 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17127 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17128 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17129 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17130 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017132src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017133 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017134 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017135 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017136 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017137 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017139src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17140 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
17141 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17142 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17143 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017144 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017146src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017147 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017148 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17149 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017150 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017152src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17153 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
17154 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17155 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017156 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017157 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017159src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17160 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17161 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17162 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017163 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017164 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17165 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017166
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017167 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017168 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017169 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017170 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017171
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017172src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17173 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17174 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17175 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
17176 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17177 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17178 connection when a first ACL was verified.
17179
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017180src_is_local : boolean
17181 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
17182 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
17183 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
17184 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017185 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017186 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
17187 once per connection.
17188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017189src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017190 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
17191 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
17192 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
17193 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
17194 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017196src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017197 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
17198 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17199 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
17200 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
17201 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017203src_port : integer
17204 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17205 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
17206 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
17207 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017209src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017210 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017211 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17212 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
17213 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017214 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017216src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17217 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
17218 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17219 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17220 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017221 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017223src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17224 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
17225 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
17226 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
17227 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
17228 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
17229 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
17230 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
17231 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017232
17233 Example :
17234 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
17235 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
17236 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
17237 listen ssh
17238 bind :22
17239 mode tcp
17240 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017241 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017242 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017243 server local 127.0.0.1:22
17244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017245srv_id : integer
17246 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
17247 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017248 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020017249
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017250srv_name : string
17251 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
17252 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017253 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017254
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172557.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017256----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020017257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017258The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
17259closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
17260when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
17261usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017262future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017263
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001726451d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
17265 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17266 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17267 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
17268 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17269 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17270
17271 Example :
17272 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
17273 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
17274 # the request.
17275 frontend http-in
17276 bind *:8081
17277 default_backend servers
17278 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17279 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17280
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017281ssl_bc : boolean
17282 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17283 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017284 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17285 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017286
17287ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
17288 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017289 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17290 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017291
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017292ssl_bc_alpn : string
17293 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
17294 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017295 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017296 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17297 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17298 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
17299 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
17300 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017301 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
17302 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017303
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017304ssl_bc_cipher : string
17305 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017306 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17307 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017308
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017309ssl_bc_client_random : binary
17310 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17311 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17312 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017313 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017314
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017315ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
17316 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17317 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017318 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17319 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017320
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017321ssl_bc_npn : string
17322 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17323 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017324 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017325 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17326 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17327 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17328 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017329 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17330 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017331
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017332ssl_bc_protocol : string
17333 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017334 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17335 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017336
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017337ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017338 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017339 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017340 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17341 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017342
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017343ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17344 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17345 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17346 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017347 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017348
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017349ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17350 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17351 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017352 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17353 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017354
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017355ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17356 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17357 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17358 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017359 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017360
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017361ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17362 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017363 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17364 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017366ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17367 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17368 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17369 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17370 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17371 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017373ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17374 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17375 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17376 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17377 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017378
Christopher Faulet7a507632020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017379ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017380 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17381 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17382 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17383 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17384 does not support resumed sessions.
17385
Christopher Faulet7a507632020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017386ssl_c_der : binary
17387 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17388 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17389 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017391ssl_c_err : integer
17392 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17393 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17394 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17395 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17396 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017397
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017398ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017399 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17400 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17401 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17402 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17403 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17404 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17405 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17406 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017407 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17408 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17409 LDAP v3.
17410 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17411 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017413ssl_c_key_alg : string
17414 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17415 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17416 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017418ssl_c_notafter : string
17419 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17420 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17421 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017423ssl_c_notbefore : string
17424 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17425 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17426 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017427
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017428ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017429 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17430 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17431 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17432 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17433 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17434 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17435 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17436 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017437 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17438 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17439 LDAP v3.
17440 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17441 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017443ssl_c_serial : binary
17444 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17445 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17446 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017448ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17449 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17450 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17451 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017452 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17453 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17454
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017455 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017456 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017458ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17459 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17460 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17461 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017463ssl_c_used : boolean
17464 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17465 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017467ssl_c_verify : integer
17468 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17469 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17470 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17471 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017473ssl_c_version : integer
17474 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17475 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017476
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017477ssl_f_der : binary
17478 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17479 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17480 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17481
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017482ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017483 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17484 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17485 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17486 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017487 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017488 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17489 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17490 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017491 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17492 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17493 LDAP v3.
17494 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17495 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017497ssl_f_key_alg : string
17498 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17499 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17500 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017502ssl_f_notafter : string
17503 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17504 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17505 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017507ssl_f_notbefore : string
17508 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17509 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17510 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017511
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017512ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017513 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17514 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17515 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17516 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17517 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17518 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17519 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17520 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017521 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17522 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17523 LDAP v3.
17524 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17525 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017527ssl_f_serial : binary
17528 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17529 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17530 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017531
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017532ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17533 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17534 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17535 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017537ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17538 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17539 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17540 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017542ssl_f_version : integer
17543 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17544 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17545
17546ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017547 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17548 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17549 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017551 Example :
17552 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17553 listen http-https
17554 bind :80
17555 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17556 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17557
17558ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17559 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17560 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17561
17562ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017563 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017564 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17565 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17566 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17567 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17568 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17569 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17570 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17571 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017573ssl_fc_cipher : string
17574 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17575 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017576
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017577ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17578 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17579 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017580 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017581
17582ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17583 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17584 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017585 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017586
17587ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17588 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17589 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17590 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017591 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017592 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017593
17594ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17595 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17596 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017597 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017598
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017599ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17600 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17601 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17602 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17603
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017604ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17605 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17606 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17607 transport layer.
17608 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17609 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17610 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17611 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17612
17613ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17614 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17615 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17616 transport layer.
17617 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17618 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17619 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17620 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17621
17622ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17623 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17624 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17625 transport layer.
17626 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17627 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17628 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17629 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17630
17631ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17632 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17633 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17634 transport layer.
17635 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17636 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17637 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17638 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17639
17640ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17641 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17642 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17643 transport layer.
17644 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17645 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17646 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17647 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017649ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017650 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17651 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017652 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17653 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17654 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17655 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017656
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017657ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17658 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17659 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17660 wait until the handshake happened.
17661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017662ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17663 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017664 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17665 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017666 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017667 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017668
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017669ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017670 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017671 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17672 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017674ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017675 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017676 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17677 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17678 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17679 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17680 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17681 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17682 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017684ssl_fc_protocol : string
17685 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17686 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017687
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017688ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017689 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017690 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17691 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017692
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017693ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17694 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17695 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17696 transport layer.
17697 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17698 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17699 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17700 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17701
17702ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
17703 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17704 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17705 transport layer.
17706 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17707 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17708 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17709 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17710
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017711ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17712 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17713 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17714 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017716ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17717 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17718 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17719 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17720 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017721
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017722ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17723 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17724 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17725 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17726 BoringSSL.
17727
17728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017729ssl_fc_sni : string
17730 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17731 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17732 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17733 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17734 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17735
17736 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17737 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17738 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017739 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017740 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017742 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017743 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17744 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017746ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17747 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17748 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017749
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017750ssl_s_der : binary
17751 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17752 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17753 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17754
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017755ssl_s_chain_der : binary
17756 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
17757 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17758 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17759 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17760 does not support resumed sessions.
17761
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017762ssl_s_key_alg : string
17763 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17764 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17765 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17766
17767ssl_s_notafter : string
17768 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17769 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17770 transport layer.
17771
17772ssl_s_notbefore : string
17773 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17774 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17775 transport layer.
17776
17777ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17778 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17779 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17780 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17781 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17782 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17783 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017784 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17785 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017786 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17787 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17788 LDAP v3.
17789 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17790 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17791
17792ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17793 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17794 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17795 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17796 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17797 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17798 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017799 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17800 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017801 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17802 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17803 LDAP v3.
17804 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17805 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17806
17807ssl_s_serial : binary
17808 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17809 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17810 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17811
17812ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17813 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17814 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17815 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17816
17817ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17818 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17819 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17820 layer.
17821
17822ssl_s_version : integer
17823 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17824 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017825
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200178267.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017827------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017829Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17830sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17831only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17832For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17833be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17834can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17835sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17836for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17837content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017839payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017840 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017841 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17842 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017844payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17845 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017846 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017847 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017849req.len : integer
17850req_len : integer (deprecated)
17851 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17852 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17853 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17854 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17855 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17856 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17857 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17858 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017860req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17861 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017862 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17863 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17864 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17865 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017867 ACL alternatives :
17868 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017870req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17871 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17872 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17873 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17874 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017876 ACL alternatives :
17877 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017879 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017881req.proto_http : boolean
17882req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17883 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17884 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17885 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17886 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17887 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17888 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17889 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017891 Example:
17892 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17893 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17894 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017895 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017897req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17898rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17899 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17900 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17901 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17902 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17903 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17904 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17905 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017907 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17908 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17909 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17910 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17911 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17912 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017914 ACL derivatives :
17915 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017917 Example :
17918 listen tse-farm
17919 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17920 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17921 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17922 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17923 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17924 persist rdp-cookie
17925 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17926 # This is only useful makes sense if
17927 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17928 stick-table type string size 204800
17929 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17930 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17931 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017933 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17934 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017936req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17937rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17938 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17939 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17940 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17941 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017943 ACL derivatives :
17944 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017945
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017946req.ssl_alpn : string
17947 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17948 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17949 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17950 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17951 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17952 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017953 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017954
17955 Examples :
17956 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17957 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17958 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017959 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017960 default_backend bk_default
17961
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017962req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17963 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17964 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017965 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17966 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17967 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17968 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17969 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017971req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17972req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17973 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17974 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17975 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17976 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17977 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17978 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17979 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017981req.ssl_sni : string
17982req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
17983 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
17984 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
17985 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
17986 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17987 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020017988 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
17989 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
17990 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
17991 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
17992 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
17993 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
17994 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
17995 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
17996 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017998 ACL derivatives :
17999 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018001 Examples :
18002 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18003 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18004 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18005 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18006 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018007
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018008req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18009 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18010 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18011 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18012 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18013 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18014 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18015 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18016 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18017 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018019req.ssl_ver : integer
18020req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18021 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18022 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18023 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18024 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18025 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18026 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18027 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018028 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018029 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018031 ACL derivatives :
18032 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018033
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018034res.len : integer
18035 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18036 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18037 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18038 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18039 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18040 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18041 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018042 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018044res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18045 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018046 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018047 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018048 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018049 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018051res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18052 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18053 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18054 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018055 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18056 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018058 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018059
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018060res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18061rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18062 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18063 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
18064 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18065 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18066 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
18067 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18068 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
18069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018070wait_end : boolean
18071 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
18072 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018073 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018074 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
18075 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018076 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018077 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
18078 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018080 Examples :
18081 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
18082 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
18083 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018085 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
18086 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18087 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
18088 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
18089 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
18090 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
18091 tcp-request content reject
18092
18093
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200180947.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018095--------------------------------------
18096
18097It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
18098This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
18099data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
18100its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
18101HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
18102content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
18103to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
18104more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
18105response are indexed.
18106
18107base : string
18108 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18109 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
18110 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
18111 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
18112 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
18113 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
18114 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
18115 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
18116
18117 ACL derivatives :
18118 base : exact string match
18119 base_beg : prefix match
18120 base_dir : subdir match
18121 base_dom : domain match
18122 base_end : suffix match
18123 base_len : length match
18124 base_reg : regex match
18125 base_sub : substring match
18126
18127base32 : integer
18128 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
18129 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
18130 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018131 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
18132 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
18133 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018134
18135base32+src : binary
18136 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
18137 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
18138 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
18139 per-URL counters.
18140
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018141capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
18142 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
18143 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18144 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
18145
18146capture.req.method : string
18147 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
18148 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
18149 because it's allocated.
18150
18151capture.req.uri : string
18152 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
18153 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
18154 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
18155 allocated.
18156
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018157capture.req.ver : string
18158 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18159 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
18160 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
18161
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018162capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
18163 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
18164 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18165 The first entry is an index of 0.
18166 See also: "capture response header"
18167
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018168capture.res.ver : string
18169 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18170 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
18171 persistent flag.
18172
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018173req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018174 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
18175 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
18176 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018177
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020018178req.body_param([<name>) : string
18179 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
18180 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
18181 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
18182 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
18183 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
18184 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
18185 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
18186 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
18187 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
18188 given.
18189
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018190req.body_len : integer
18191 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
18192 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018193 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
18194 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018195
18196req.body_size : integer
18197 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018198 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18199 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018201req.cook([<name>]) : string
18202cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18203 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18204 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
18205 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
18206 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
18207 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
18208 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
18209 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
18210 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
18211
18212 ACL derivatives :
18213 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
18214 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
18215 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
18216 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
18217 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
18218 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
18219 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
18220 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018222req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18223cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18224 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18225 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018227req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18228cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18229 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18230 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
18231 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
18232 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018234cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18235 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18236 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
18237 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
18238 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018239 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018240 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
18241 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
18242 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
18243 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018245hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18246 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
18247 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
18248 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
18249 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018250 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018252req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018253 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
18254 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
18255 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
18256 with headers such as User-Agent.
18257
18258 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
18259 found.
18260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018261 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18262 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18263 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018264 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018266req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18267 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18268 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018269 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
18270 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018272req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018273 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
18274 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
18275 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
18276 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
18277 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
18278 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
18279 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
18280
18281 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
18282 found.
18283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018284 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18285 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18286 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018287 with -1 being the last one.
18288
18289 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
18290 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018292 ACL derivatives :
18293 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18294 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18295 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18296 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18297 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18298 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18299 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18300 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18301
18302req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18303hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
18304 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18305 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018306 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
18307 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
18308 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
18309
18310 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
18311 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
18312 which contain more than one of certain headers.
18313
18314 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018315
18316req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18317hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18318 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18319 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18320 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018321 of every header is checked.
18322
18323 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
18324
18325 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018326
18327req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18328hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18329 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18330 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18331 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018332
18333 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
18334
18335 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018336
Christopher Faulet26167842020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018337req.hdrs : string
18338 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
18339 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18340 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18341 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
18342
18343req.hdrs_bin : binary
18344 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18345 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
18346 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
18347 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
18348 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
18349 names and values (length of 0 for both).
18350
18351 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018352
Christopher Faulet26167842020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018353 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18354 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018356http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18357 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18358 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18359 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18360 basic auth is supported.
18361
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018362http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18363 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18364 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18365 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18366 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018367 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18368 basic auth is supported.
18369
18370 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018371 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18372 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18373 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18374 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018375
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018376http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018377 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18378 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18379 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018380
18381http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018382 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18383 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18384 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018385
18386http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018387 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18388 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18389 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018391http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018392 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18393 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018394 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18395 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018397method : integer + string
18398 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18399 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18400 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18401 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18402 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18403 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18404 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018406 ACL derivatives :
18407 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018409 Example :
18410 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18411 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18412 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018414path : string
18415 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18416 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18417 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18418 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18419 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018420 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018421 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018423 ACL derivatives :
18424 path : exact string match
18425 path_beg : prefix match
18426 path_dir : subdir match
18427 path_dom : domain match
18428 path_end : suffix match
18429 path_len : length match
18430 path_reg : regex match
18431 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018432
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020018433pathq : string
18434 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
18435 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
18436 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
18437 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
18438 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
18439 result in both cases.
18440
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018441query : string
18442 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18443 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18444 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18445 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018446 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018447 which stops before the question mark.
18448
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018449req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18450 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18451 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18452 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18453 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018455req.ver : string
18456req_ver : string (deprecated)
18457 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18458 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18459 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018461 ACL derivatives :
18462 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018463
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018464res.body : binary
18465 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18466 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018467 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
18468
18469 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018470
18471res.body_len : integer
18472 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18473 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018474 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
18475
18476 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018477
18478res.body_size : integer
18479 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18480 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18481 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18482 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018483 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
18484
18485 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018486
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010018487res.cache_hit : boolean
18488 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
18489 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
18490
18491res.cache_name : string
18492 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
18493 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
18494 empty string.
18495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018496res.comp : boolean
18497 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18498 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18499 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018501res.comp_algo : string
18502 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18503 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18504 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018506res.cook([<name>]) : string
18507scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18508 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18509 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018510 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
18511
18512 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018514 ACL derivatives :
18515 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018517res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18518scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18519 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18520 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018521 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
18522
18523 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018525res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18526scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18527 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18528 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018529 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
18530
18531 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018533res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018534 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
18535 on the headers within an HTTP response.
18536
18537 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
18538 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
18539
18540 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
18541
18542 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018544res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018545 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
18546 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
18547
18548 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
18549 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
18550
18551 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018553res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18554shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018555 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
18556 on the headers within an HTTP response.
18557
18558 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimeter. If
18559 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
18560
18561 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018563 ACL derivatives :
18564 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18565 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18566 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18567 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18568 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18569 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18570 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18571 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18572
18573res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18574shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018575 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
18576 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
18577
18578 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
18579 delimeter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
18580
18581 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018583res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18584shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018585 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
18586 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
18587
18588 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
18589
18590 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018591
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018592res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18593 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18594 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18595 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018596 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18597
18598 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018600res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18601shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018602 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
18603 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
18604
18605 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
18606
18607 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018608
18609res.hdrs : string
18610 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18611 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18612 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018613 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
18614
18615 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018616
18617res.hdrs_bin : binary
18618 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18619 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18620 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18621 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18622 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18623 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18624 (length of 0 for both).
18625
18626 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18627
18628 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18629 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018631res.ver : string
18632resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18633 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018634 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
18635
18636 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018638 ACL derivatives :
18639 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018641set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18642 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18643 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018644 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018645 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018647 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18648 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018650status : integer
18651 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18652 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018653 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
18654
18655 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018656
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018657unique-id : string
18658 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18659 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18660 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18661 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18662 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18663 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018665url : string
18666 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18667 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18668 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18669 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18670 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18671 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18672 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018674 ACL derivatives :
18675 url : exact string match
18676 url_beg : prefix match
18677 url_dir : subdir match
18678 url_dom : domain match
18679 url_end : suffix match
18680 url_len : length match
18681 url_reg : regex match
18682 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018684url_ip : ip
18685 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
18686 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
18687 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
18688 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
18689 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18690 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18691 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018693url_port : integer
18694 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18695 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18696 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18697 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018698
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018699urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18700url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018701 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18702 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018703 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18704 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18705 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18706 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018707 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18708 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018709 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18710 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018712 ACL derivatives :
18713 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18714 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18715 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18716 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18717 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18718 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18719 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18720 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018721
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018723 Example :
18724 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18725 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18726 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18727 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018728
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018729urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018730 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18731 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18732 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018733
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018734url32 : integer
18735 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18736 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18737 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18738 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18739 is an unsigned integer.
18740
18741url32+src : binary
18742 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18743 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18744 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18745
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018746
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200187477.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018748---------------------------------------
18749
18750This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18751used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18752purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18753There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18754or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18755any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18756for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18757
18758internal.htx.data : integer
18759 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18760 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18761
18762internal.htx.free : integer
18763 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18764 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18765
18766internal.htx.free_data : integer
18767 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18768 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18769
18770internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18771 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18772 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18773 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18774
18775internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18776 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18777 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18778
18779internal.htx.size : integer
18780 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18781 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18782
18783internal.htx.used : integer
18784 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18785 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18786 direction.
18787
18788internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18789 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18790 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18791 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18792 of the special value :
18793 * head : The oldest inserted block
18794 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018795 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018796
18797internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18798 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18799 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18800 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18801 integer or one of the special value :
18802 * head : The oldest inserted block
18803 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018804 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018805
18806internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18807 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18808 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18809 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18810 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18811
18812 * head : The oldest inserted block
18813 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018814 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018815
18816internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18817 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18818 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18819 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18820 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18821
18822 * head : The oldest inserted block
18823 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018824 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018825
18826internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18827 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18828 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18829 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18830 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18831
18832 * head : The oldest inserted block
18833 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018834 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018835
18836internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18837 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18838 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18839 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18840 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18841
18842 * head : The oldest inserted block
18843 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018844 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018845
18846internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18847 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18848 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18849 it returns false.
18850
18851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200188527.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018853---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018854
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018855Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18856every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018857order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018858
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018859ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18860---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018861FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018862HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018863HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18864HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018865HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18866HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18867HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18868HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18869LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018870METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018871METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018872METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18873METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18874METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18875METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018876METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018877METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018878RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018879REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018880TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018881WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18882---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018883
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018884
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188858. Logging
18886----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018887
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018888One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18889provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18890very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18891provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18892state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018893to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018894headers.
18895
18896In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18897about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18898send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18899
18900 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18901 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18902 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18903 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18904 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018905 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018906 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018907
18908The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18909allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18910as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18911while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18912real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18913delay.
18914
18915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189168.1. Log levels
18917---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018918
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018919TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018920source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018921HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18922in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18923track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18924syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18925about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018926
18927
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189288.2. Log formats
18929----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018930
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018931HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018932and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18933slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18934options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018935
18936 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18937 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18938 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18939 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18940 extents.
18941
18942 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18943 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18944 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18945 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18946 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18947
18948 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18949 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18950 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18951 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18952 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18953
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018954 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18955 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18956 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18957 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18958
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018959 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18960
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018961Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18962specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18963field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18964servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18965always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18966identifier.
18967
18968Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18969 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18970 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18971 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18972 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18973
18974
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189758.2.1. Default log format
18976-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018977
18978This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
18979as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
18980format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
18981
18982 Example :
18983 listen www
18984 mode http
18985 log global
18986 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18987
18988 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
18989 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
18990 (www/HTTP)
18991
18992 Field Format Extract from the example above
18993 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
18994 2 'Connect from' Connect from
18995 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
18996 4 'to' to
18997 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
18998 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
18999
19000Detailed fields description :
19001 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19002 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19003 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19004 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19005 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19006 and processed the connection.
19007 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19008
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019009In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19010"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19011connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19012
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019013It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19014will eventually disappear.
19015
19016
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190178.2.2. TCP log format
19018---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019019
19020The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19021is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19022information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
19023counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
19024emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
19025environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
19026the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
19027sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019028specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
19029not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
19030fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
19031marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019032
19033 Example :
19034 frontend fnt
19035 mode tcp
19036 option tcplog
19037 log global
19038 default_backend bck
19039
19040 backend bck
19041 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19042
19043 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
19044 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
19045 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
19046
19047 Field Format Extract from the example above
19048 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
19049 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
19050 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
19051 4 frontend_name fnt
19052 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
19053 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
19054 7 bytes_read* 212
19055 8 termination_state --
19056 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
19057 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19058
19059Detailed fields description :
19060 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019061 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19062 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19063 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019064 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019065 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019066 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019067
19068 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019069 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19070 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19071 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019072
19073 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
19074 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
19075 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019076 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
19077 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
19078 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
19079 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019080
19081 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19082 and processed the connection.
19083
19084 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19085 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19086 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
19087 applications.
19088
19089 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19090 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19091 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19092 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
19093 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
19094
19095 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19096 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
19097 See "Timers" below for more details.
19098
19099 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19100 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
19101 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
19102 "Timers" below for more details.
19103
19104 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019105 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019106 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
19107 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
19108 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
19109 details.
19110
19111 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
19112 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
19113 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
19114 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
19115 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
19116
19117 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19118 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19119 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
19120 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
19121 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
19122 for more details.
19123
19124 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019125 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019126 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
19127 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
19128 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019129 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019130
19131 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19132 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19133 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19134 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19135 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19136 caused by a denial of service attack.
19137
19138 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19139 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19140 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19141 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19142 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19143 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19144 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19145 denial of service attack.
19146
19147 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19148 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19149 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19150 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19151 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19152 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19153 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19154 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
19155 be processed than on other servers.
19156
19157 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19158 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19159 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19160 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19161 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19162 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19163 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19164 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19165 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19166 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19167 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19168 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19169 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19170
19171 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19172 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19173 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19174 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19175 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19176 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019177 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019178 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19179
19180 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19181 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19182 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19183 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19184 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19185 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019186 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019187 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19188 occurs.
19189
19190
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191918.2.3. HTTP log format
19192----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019193
19194The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
19195is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
19196the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
19197are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
19198emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
19199generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
19200"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
19201which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019202frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
19203is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019204
19205Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
19206slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
19207with a star ('*') after the field name below.
19208
19209 Example :
19210 frontend http-in
19211 mode http
19212 option httplog
19213 log global
19214 default_backend bck
19215
19216 backend static
19217 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19218
19219 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
19220 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
19221 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019222 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019223
19224 Field Format Extract from the example above
19225 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
19226 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019227 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019228 4 frontend_name http-in
19229 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019230 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019231 7 status_code 200
19232 8 bytes_read* 2750
19233 9 captured_request_cookie -
19234 10 captured_response_cookie -
19235 11 termination_state ----
19236 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
19237 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19238 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
19239 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
19240 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019241
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019242Detailed fields description :
19243 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019244 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19245 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19246 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019247 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019248 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019249 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019250
19251 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019252 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19253 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19254 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019255
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019256 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
19257 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019258
19259 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19260 and processed the connection.
19261
19262 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19263 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19264 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
19265
19266 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19267 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19268 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19269 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
19270 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
19271 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
19272
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019273 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
19274 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
19275 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019276 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019277 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
19278 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019279 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
19280 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019281
19282 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19283 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019284 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019285
19286 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19287 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019288 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
19289 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019290
19291 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
19292 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
19293 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
19294 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
19295 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019296 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
19297 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019298
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019299 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
19300 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
19301 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
19302 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
19303 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
19304 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
19305 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019306 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019307
19308 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
19309 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
19310 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
19311
19312 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
19313 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019314 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019315 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
19316 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
19317 overflowing.
19318
19319 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
19320 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
19321 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
19322 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
19323 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
19324 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
19325 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
19326 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19327
19328 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
19329 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
19330 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
19331 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
19332 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
19333 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
19334 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
19335 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19336
19337 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19338 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19339 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
19340 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
19341 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
19342 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
19343 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
19344
19345 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019346 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019347 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
19348 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
19349 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019350 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019351 system.
19352
19353 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19354 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19355 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19356 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19357 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19358 caused by a denial of service attack.
19359
19360 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19361 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19362 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19363 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19364 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19365 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19366 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19367 denial of service attack.
19368
19369 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19370 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19371 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19372 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19373 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19374 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19375 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19376 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19377 processed than on other servers.
19378
19379 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19380 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19381 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19382 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19383 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19384 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19385 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19386 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19387 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19388 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19389 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19390 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19391 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19392
19393 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19394 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19395 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19396 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19397 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19398 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019399 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019400 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19401
19402 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19403 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19404 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19405 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19406 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19407 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019408 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019409 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19410 occurs.
19411
19412 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19413 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19414 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19415 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19416 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19417 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19418 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19419 cookies" below for more details.
19420
19421 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19422 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19423 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19424 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19425 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19426 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19427 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19428 and cookies" below for more details.
19429
19430 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19431 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19432 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19433 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19434 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19435 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19436 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19437 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19438
19439
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200194408.2.4. Custom log format
19441------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019442
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019443The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019444mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019445
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019446HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019447Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19448separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19449prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19450
19451Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19452variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019453("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019454
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019455If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019456as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019457less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19458the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19459
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019460Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19461"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19462delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19463preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019464
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019465Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19466'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19467https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19468such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19469
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019470Flags are :
19471 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019472 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019473 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19474 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019475
19476 Example:
19477
19478 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19479 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19480
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019481 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19482
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019483At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19484
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019485 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19486 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019487
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019488the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019489
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019490 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19491 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19492 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019493
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019494and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19495
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019496 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19497 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019498
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019499Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19500
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019501 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019502 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019503 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19504 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19505 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019506 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19507 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19508 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019509 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019510 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdebf9f0f942020-11-26 10:45:52 +000019511 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019512 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019513 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19514 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019515 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019516 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019517 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019518 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019519 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019520 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019521 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019522 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19523 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19524 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19525 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19526 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019527 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019528 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019529 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019530 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019531 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019532 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19533 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019534 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19535 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19536 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019537 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019538 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19539 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019540 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019541 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19542 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19543 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019544 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019545 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019546 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19547 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19548 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19549 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019550 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019551 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019552 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019553 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019554 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019555 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019556 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19557 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19558 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019559 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019560 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19561 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019562 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019563 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19564 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019565 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019566 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019567 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019568 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019569
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019570 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019571
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019572
195738.2.5. Error log format
19574-----------------------
19575
19576When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19577protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19578By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19579"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019580will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019581logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19582
19583The format looks like this :
19584
19585 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
19586 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
19587 Connection error during SSL handshake
19588
19589 Field Format Extract from the example above
19590 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
19591 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
19592 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
19593 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19594 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19595
19596These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19597failures.
19598
19599
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196008.3. Advanced logging options
19601-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019602
19603Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19604just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19605options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19606for more information about their usage.
19607
19608
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196098.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19610------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019611
19612It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19613haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19614commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19615monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19616ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19617
19618 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19619 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19620 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19621 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19622
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020019623 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
19624 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019625
19626 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19627 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19628 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19629
19630
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196318.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19632----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019633
19634The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19635what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19636or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019637"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019638just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19639log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19640after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19641is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19642with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19643with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19644
19645
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196468.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19647------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019648
19649Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19650for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19651"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19652retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19653raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19654a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19655file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19656you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19657"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19658
19659
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196608.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19661--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019662
19663Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19664multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19665them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19666"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19667logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19668error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19669and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19670too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19671useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19672alternative.
19673
19674
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196758.4. Timing events
19676------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019677
19678Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19679reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
19680the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
19681frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019682mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
19683addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
19684
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019685Timings events in HTTP mode:
19686
19687 first request 2nd request
19688 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19689 t tr t tr ...
19690 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19691 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19692 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19693 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019694 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019695 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19696
19697Timings events in TCP mode:
19698
19699 TCP session
19700 |<----------------->|
19701 t t
19702 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19703 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19704 |<------ Tt ------->|
19705
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019706 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019707 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019708 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19709 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19710 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019711 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019712 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19713 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19714 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19715 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019716
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019717 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19718 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19719 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019720 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19721 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19722 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19723 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19724 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19725 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019726
19727 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19728 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19729 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19730 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19731 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19732 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19733 request typed by hand during a test.
19734
19735 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19736 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019737 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019738 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19739 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19740 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19741 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019742
19743 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19744 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19745 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19746 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19747 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19748
19749 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19750 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19751 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19752 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19753 connection never established.
19754
19755 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19756 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19757 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19758 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19759 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19760 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19761 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19762 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19763 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19764 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19765 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19766
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019767 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19768 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19769 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19770 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19771 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19772 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19773
19774 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19775
19776 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19777 "Ta" can never be negative.
19778
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019779 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19780 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019781 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19782 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019783 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019784
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019785 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019786
19787 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019788 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19789 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019790
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019791 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19792 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19793 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19794 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19795 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19796 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19797 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19798 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19799
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019800These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19801protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19802that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019803due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19804"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19805that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019806
19807Most common cases :
19808
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019809 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19810 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19811 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19812 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19813 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19814 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19815 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19816 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19817 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19818 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19819 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019820 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019821
19822 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19823 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19824 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19825 of ms on remote networks.
19826
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019827 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19828 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19829 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019830
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019831 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19832 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19833 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19834 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19835 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19836 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19837 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19838 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19839 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019840
19841Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19842
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019843 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019844 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019845 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019846
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019847 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019848 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19849 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19850
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019851 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019852 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19853 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19854 flags.
19855
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019856 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19857 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019858 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19859 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19860 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19861 the client connection was maintained open.
19862
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019863 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019864 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019865 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019866 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19867
19868
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198698.5. Session state at disconnection
19870-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019871
19872TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19873"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
198742-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19875each of which has a special meaning :
19876
19877 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19878 session to terminate :
19879
19880 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19881
19882 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19883 server explicitly refused it.
19884
19885 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19886 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19887 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19888 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019889 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019890
19891 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19892 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019893
19894 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19895 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19896 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19897 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19898 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19899
19900 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19901 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19902 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19903 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19904 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19905
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019906 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19907 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19908
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019909 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19910 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19911 backup connections when going up.
19912
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019913 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19914
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019915 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19916 send or receive data.
19917
19918 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19919 send or receive data.
19920
19921 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19922 with nothing left in the buffers.
19923
19924 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19925
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019926 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019927 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19928
19929 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19930 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19931 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19932 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19933 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19934
19935 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19936 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19937
19938 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19939 server (HTTP only).
19940
19941 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19942
19943 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19944 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19945 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19946
19947 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19948 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19949 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19950
19951 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19952
19953 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19954 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19955
19956 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19957 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19958 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19959
19960 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19961 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019962 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19963 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019964
19965 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19966 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19967 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19968 another server.
19969
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019970 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019971 server.
19972
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019973 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19974 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19975 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19976 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19977
19978 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
19979 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
19980 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
19981 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19982
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020019983 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
19984 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
19985 "use-server" rule).
19986
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019987 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19988
19989 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
19990 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
19991
19992 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
19993
19994 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
19995 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
19996 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
19997
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019998 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
19999 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020000 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020001 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20002 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20003
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020004 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20005
20006 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20007 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20008
20009 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20010
20011 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20012
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020013The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20014was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020015helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20016starvation, attacks, etc...
20017
20018The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20019alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20020easier finding and understanding.
20021
20022 Flags Reason
20023
20024 -- Normal termination.
20025
20026 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
20027 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
20028 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
20029 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
20030
20031 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
20032 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
20033 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
20034 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
20035 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
20036 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020037
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020038 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20039 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020040 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020041
20042 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
20043 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
20044 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
20045
20046 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
20047 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
20048 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
20049 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
20050 the server takes too long to respond.
20051
20052 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
20053 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
20054 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
20055 long a time to respond.
20056
20057 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
20058 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
20059 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
20060 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020061 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
20062 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020063
20064 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
20065 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
20066 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
20067 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
20068 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020020069 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020070 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
20071 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
20072 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
20073 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
20074 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
20075 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
20076 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
20077 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020078 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020079 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
20080 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
20081 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020082
20083 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
20084 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020085 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
20086 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
20087 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
20088 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020089
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020090 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
20091 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
20092
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020093 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020094 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
20095 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020096 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020097 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
20098 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
20099
20100 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
20101 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
20102 503 or 504 here.
20103
20104 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
20105 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
20106 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
20107 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
20108 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
20109
20110 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20111 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020112 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020113 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
20114 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
20115
20116 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
20117 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
20118 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
20119 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
20120 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
20121 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
20122 between haproxy and the server.
20123
20124 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
20125 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
20126 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
20127 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
20128 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
20129 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
20130 solution is to fix the application.
20131
20132 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
20133 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
20134 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
20135 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
20136 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
20137 external attacks.
20138
20139 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombsdab4ba62021-01-07 21:24:41 -070020140 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020141 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020142 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
20143 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
20144
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020145 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
20146 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
20147 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020148 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020020149 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020150
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020151 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
20152 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
20153 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
20154 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020155 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
20156 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
20157 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
20158 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
20159 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020160
20161 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
20162 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
20163 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
20164 returned an HTTP 403 error.
20165
20166 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
20167 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
20168 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
20169 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
20170
20171 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
20172 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
20173 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
20174 only be solved by proper system tuning.
20175
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020176The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
20177persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
20178important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
20179re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
20180
20181 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
20182
20183 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20184 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
20185 set on a GET request.
20186
20187 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
20188 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020189 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020190 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
20191
20192 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
20193 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
20194 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
20195
20196 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20197 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
20198 already got a cookie.
20199
20200 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20201 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
20202 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
20203 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
20204 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
20205
20206 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20207 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20208 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20209
20210 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
20211 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20212 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20213
20214 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
20215 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
20216
20217 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
20218 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
20219 then advertised in the response.
20220
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020221
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202228.6. Non-printable characters
20223-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020224
20225In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
20226consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
20227converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
20228prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
20229being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
20230escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
20231is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
20232'}' when logging headers.
20233
20234Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
20235issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
20236containing spaces is "User-Agent".
20237
20238Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
20239the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
20240performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
20241
20242
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202438.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
20244---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020245
20246Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
20247achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020248section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020249cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
20250the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
20251the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020252locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020253not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
20254user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
20255a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
20256wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
20257
20258 Examples :
20259 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
20260 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
20261
20262 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
20263 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
20264
20265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202668.8. Capturing HTTP headers
20267---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020268
20269Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
20270proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
20271the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
20272server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
20273
20274Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
20275response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020276section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020277
20278It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020279time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
20280appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020281are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
20282and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
20283follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
20284request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
20285in the logs.
20286
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020287As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
20288frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
20289an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
20290
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020291 Example :
20292 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
20293 listen proxy-out
20294 mode http
20295 option httplog
20296 option logasap
20297 log global
20298 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
20299
20300 # log the name of the virtual server
20301 capture request header Host len 20
20302
20303 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
20304 capture request header Content-Length len 10
20305
20306 # log the beginning of the referrer
20307 capture request header Referer len 20
20308
20309 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
20310 capture response header Server len 20
20311
20312 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
20313 capture response header Content-Length len 10
20314
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020315 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020316 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
20317
20318 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
20319 capture response header Via len 20
20320
20321 # log the URL location during a redirection
20322 capture response header Location len 20
20323
20324 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
20325 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
20326 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20327 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
20328 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
20329
20330 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20331 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20332 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20333 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020334 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020335
20336 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20337 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20338 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20339 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
20340 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020341 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020342
20343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203448.9. Examples of logs
20345---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020346
20347These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
20348them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
20349reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
20350
20351 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
20352 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20353 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20354
20355 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20356 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20357
20358 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20359 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20360 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20361
20362 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20363 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20364
20365 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20366 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20367 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20368
20369 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020370 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020371 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20372 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20373
20374 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20375 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20376 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20377
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020378 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20379 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20380 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20381 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20382 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20383 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020384
20385 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020386 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020387
20388 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20389 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20390 Nothing was sent to any server.
20391
20392 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20393 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20394
20395 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20396 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020397 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020398 send a 408 return code to the client.
20399
20400 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20401 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20402
20403 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20404 5 seconds ("c----").
20405
20406 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20407 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020408 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020409
20410 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020411 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020412 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20413 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20414 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20415 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20416 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020417
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020418
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200204199. Supported filters
20420--------------------
20421
20422Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20423accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20424unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20425
20426See also : "filter"
20427
204289.1. Trace
20429----------
20430
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020431filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020432
20433 Arguments:
20434 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20435 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20436
20437 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
20438 the client and the server. By default, this filter
20439 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
20440 only parses a random amount of the available data.
20441
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020442 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020443 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20444 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20445 amount of the parsed data.
20446
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020447 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020448
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020449This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20450callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20451information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20452filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20453
20454Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20455tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20456a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20457
20458
204599.2. HTTP compression
20460---------------------
20461
20462filter compression
20463
20464The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20465keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020466when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20467fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20468done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20469explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20470filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20471listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20472order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020473
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020474See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20475 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020476
20477
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200204789.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20479--------------------------------------------
20480
20481filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20482
20483 Arguments :
20484
20485 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20486 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20487 parsed.
20488
20489 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20490 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20491 part must be placed in its own scope.
20492
20493The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20494external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020495streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020496exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20497also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20498
20499SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20500the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20501
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020502For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020503"doc/SPOE.txt".
20504
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100205059.4. Cache
20506----------
20507
20508filter cache <name>
20509
20510 Arguments :
20511
20512 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20513
20514The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20515"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020516cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020517other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20518case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20519is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20520filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020521listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20522order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020523
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020524See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20525 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20526
20527
205289.5. Fcgi-app
20529-------------
20530
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020531filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020532
20533 Arguments :
20534
20535 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20536
20537The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20538request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20539reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20540used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20541implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20542used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20543fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20544used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20545order.
20546
20547See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20548 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20549
20550
2055110. FastCGI applications
20552-------------------------
20553
20554HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
20555feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
20556the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
20557FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
20558servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
20559FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
20560backend.
20561
20562HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
20563application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
20564connection.
20565
2056610.1. Setup
20567-----------
20568
2056910.1.1. Fcgi-app section
20570--------------------------
20571
20572fcgi-app <name>
20573 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
20574 document root must be defined.
20575
20576acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
20577 Declare or complete an access list.
20578
20579 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
20580 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
20581 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
20582 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
20583 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
20584
20585docroot <path>
20586 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
20587 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
20588 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
20589
20590index <script-name>
20591 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20592 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20593 is an optional setting.
20594
20595 Example :
20596 index index.php
20597
20598log-stderr global
20599log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagnerf2f5c4e2020-12-17 22:22:32 +010020600 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020601 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20602
20603 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20604 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20605
20606pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20607 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20608 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20609 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20610
20611 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20612 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20613 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20614 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20615
20616 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20617 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20618
20619path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020620 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020621 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20622 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20623 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20624 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20625 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20626 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20627 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020628
20629 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020630 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020631 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20632 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20633 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20634 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020635
20636 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020637 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20638 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020639
20640option get-values
20641no option get-values
20642 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20643
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020644 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020645 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20646
20647 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20648 application will accept.
20649
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020020650 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
20651 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020652
20653 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050020654 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020655 option is disabled.
20656
20657 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
20658 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
20659 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
20660 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
20661 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
20662 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
20663
20664option keep-conn
20665no option keep-conn
20666 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
20667 sending a response.
20668
20669 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
20670 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
20671
20672option max-reqs <reqs>
20673 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
20674 accept.
20675
20676 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
20677 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
20678 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
20679 to 1.
20680
20681option mpxs-conns
20682no option mpxs-conns
20683 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
20684
20685 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
20686 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20687
20688set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20689 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20690 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20691 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20692 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20693
20694 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20695 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20696 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20697
20698 Example :
20699 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20700 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20701
20702 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20703
20704
2070510.1.2. Proxy section
20706---------------------
20707
20708use-fcgi-app <name>
20709 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20710
20711 Arguments :
20712 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20713
20714 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20715 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20716 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20717 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20718 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20719
20720 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20721 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20722 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20723 application are evaluated.
20724
20725
2072610.1.3. Example
20727---------------
20728
20729 frontend front-http
20730 mode http
20731 bind *:80
20732 bind *:
20733
20734 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20735 default_backend back-static
20736
20737 backend back-static
20738 mode http
20739 server www A.B.C.D:80
20740
20741 backend back-dynamic
20742 mode http
20743 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20744 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20745
20746 fcgi-app php-fpm
20747 log-stderr global
20748 option keep-conn
20749
20750 docroot /var/www/my-app
20751 index index.php
20752 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20753
20754
2075510.2. Default parameters
20756------------------------
20757
20758A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20759the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020760script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020761applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20762
20763 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20764 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20765 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20766 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20767 | | |
20768 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20769 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20770 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20771 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20772 | | application. |
20773 | | |
20774 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20775 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20776 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20777 | | |
20778 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20779 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20780 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20781 | | the application's configuration. |
20782 | | |
20783 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20784 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20785 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20786 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20787 | | |
20788 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20789 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20790 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20791 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20792 | | be defined. |
20793 | | |
20794 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20795 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20796 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20797 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20798 | | is not set too. |
20799 | | |
20800 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20801 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20802 | | set. |
20803 | | |
20804 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20805 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20806 | | the request. |
20807 | | |
20808 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20809 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20810 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20811 | | |
20812 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20813 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20814 | | script to process the request. |
20815 | | |
20816 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20817 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20818 | | |
20819 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20820 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20821 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20822 | | |
20823 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20824 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20825 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20826 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20827 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20828 | | |
20829 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20830 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20831 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20832 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20833 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20834 | | side. |
20835 | | |
20836 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20837 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20838 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20839 | | connected to. |
20840 | | |
20841 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20842 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20843 | | |
20844 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20845 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20846 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20847 | | |
20848 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20849
20850
2085110.3. Limitations
20852------------------
20853
20854The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20855way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20856during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20857establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20858application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20859or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20860message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20861these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20862and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20863
20864Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20865request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20866requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20867
20868About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20869into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20870fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20871"http-request" ones.
20872
20873Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20874FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20875processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20876must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20877here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020878
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020879/*
20880 * Local variables:
20881 * fill-column: 79
20882 * End:
20883 */